1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.75"
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>17 May 2012</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.80.1</revnumber>
178 <date>24 Oct 2012</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2012</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
743 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
773 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1651 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1652 .cindex "PCRE library"
1653 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1654 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1655 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1656 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1657 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1658 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1659 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1660 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1661 If your operating system has no
1662 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1664 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1667 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1675 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1684 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691 Berkeley DB library.
1693 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1698 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1701 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705 file name is used unmodified.
1707 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1712 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1716 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1718 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1723 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726 operates on a single file.
1730 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1738 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1741 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1748 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750 in one of these lines:
1755 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1761 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1764 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1769 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1782 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1789 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1797 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800 facilities, you need to set
1802 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1804 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1808 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1816 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1825 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1828 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1836 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1844 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1848 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1860 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1864 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1867 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1869 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1873 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1877 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1878 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1881 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1884 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1885 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1889 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1891 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1892 library and include files. For example:
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1900 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1901 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1905 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1909 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1910 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1911 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1916 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1918 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1919 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1920 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1921 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1922 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1923 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1924 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1925 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1926 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1927 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1928 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1929 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1932 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1933 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1934 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1936 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1937 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1939 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1941 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1942 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1943 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1944 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1945 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1946 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1950 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1951 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1952 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1953 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1954 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1955 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1958 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1959 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1960 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1961 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1962 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1963 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1964 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1965 support has not been tested for some time.
1969 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1970 .cindex "lookup modules"
1971 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1972 .cindex ".so building"
1973 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1974 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1976 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1977 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1979 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1981 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1982 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1983 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1984 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1985 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1986 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1988 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1989 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1990 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1999 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2000 .cindex "build directory"
2001 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2002 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2003 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2004 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2005 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2006 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2007 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2009 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2010 building process fails if it is set.
2012 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2013 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2014 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2015 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2016 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2017 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2018 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2019 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2021 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2022 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2023 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2027 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2028 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2029 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2030 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2031 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2032 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2033 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2037 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2038 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2039 given in addition to the short output.
2043 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2044 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2045 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2046 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2047 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2048 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2049 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2052 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2053 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2055 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2056 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2057 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2058 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2060 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2061 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2062 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2063 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2064 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2065 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2066 and are often not needed.
2068 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2069 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2070 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2071 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2072 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2073 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2074 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2075 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2076 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2079 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2080 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2081 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2082 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2087 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2089 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2090 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2091 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2092 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2093 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2094 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2095 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2096 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2097 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2098 containing the lines
2103 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2104 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2106 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2107 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2108 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2111 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2112 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2113 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2114 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2115 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2116 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2117 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2118 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2119 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2120 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2126 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2127 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2128 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2129 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2130 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2131 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2132 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2133 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2137 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2138 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2139 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2140 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2141 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2142 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2143 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2144 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2145 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2146 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2147 syntax. For instance:
2150 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2152 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2153 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2154 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2158 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2159 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2160 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2164 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2165 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2167 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2168 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2169 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2170 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2171 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2172 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2175 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2176 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2178 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2179 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2182 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2183 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2185 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2186 definition of all three of these variables into your
2187 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2190 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2191 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2192 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2193 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2195 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2196 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2197 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2198 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2199 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2202 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2203 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2204 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2205 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2206 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2209 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2211 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2212 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2213 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2214 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2215 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2216 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2220 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2221 .cindex "building Eximon"
2222 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2223 where the files that are involved are
2225 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2226 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2227 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2228 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2229 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2230 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2232 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2233 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2234 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2235 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2236 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2237 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2238 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2242 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2243 .cindex "installing Exim"
2244 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2245 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2246 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2247 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2248 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2249 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2250 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2251 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2252 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2253 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2254 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2255 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2257 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2258 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2259 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2260 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2261 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2262 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2263 alternative files, no default is installed.
2265 .cindex "system aliases file"
2266 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2267 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2268 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2269 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2270 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2271 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2272 and outputs a comment to the user.
2274 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2275 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2276 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2277 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2278 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2280 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2281 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2282 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2283 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2284 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2287 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2288 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2291 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2293 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2294 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2295 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2296 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2297 but this usage is deprecated.
2299 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2300 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2301 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2302 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2303 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2304 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2306 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2307 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2308 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2309 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2310 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2311 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2312 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2314 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2315 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2316 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2319 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2321 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2322 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2323 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2324 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2327 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2329 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2330 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2333 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2334 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2336 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2340 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2344 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2345 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2346 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2348 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2353 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2354 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2355 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2356 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2357 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2360 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2361 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2362 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2366 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2367 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2368 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2369 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2370 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2376 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2377 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2378 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2379 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2380 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2384 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2385 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2386 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2387 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2388 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2391 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2393 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2395 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2397 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2398 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2399 user agent. For example:
2401 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2402 From: user@your.domain.example
2403 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2404 Subject: Testing Exim
2406 This is a test message.
2409 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2410 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2411 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2413 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2414 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2415 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2416 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2417 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2418 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2420 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2422 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2423 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2424 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2425 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2426 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2428 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2429 .cindex "lock files"
2430 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2431 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2432 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2433 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2434 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2435 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2436 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2437 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2438 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2439 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2440 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2441 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2443 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2444 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2445 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2446 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2447 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2450 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2451 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2452 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2453 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2457 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2458 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2459 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2460 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2461 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2462 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2463 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2464 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2465 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2466 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2467 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2468 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2469 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2471 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2472 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2473 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2474 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2475 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2476 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2479 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2480 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2481 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2482 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2484 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2485 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2486 favourite user agent.
2488 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2489 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2490 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2491 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2492 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2493 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2497 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2498 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2499 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2500 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2501 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2502 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2503 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2504 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2510 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2511 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2512 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2514 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2516 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2517 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2518 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2519 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2520 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2522 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2524 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2526 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2527 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2528 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2536 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2537 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2538 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2539 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2540 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2541 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2542 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2543 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2544 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2547 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2549 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2550 were present before any other options.
2551 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2553 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2554 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2555 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2558 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2559 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2560 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2564 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2565 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2566 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2569 .cindex "queue runner"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2571 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2572 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2574 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2575 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2576 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2577 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2578 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2579 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2580 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2581 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2584 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2585 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2586 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2587 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2588 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2589 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2592 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2593 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2594 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2595 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2596 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2597 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2599 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2600 .cindex "envelope sender"
2601 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2602 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2603 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2604 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2605 users to set envelope senders.
2607 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2608 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2609 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2610 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2611 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2613 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2614 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2615 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2616 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2617 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2618 that are available to trusted users.
2620 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2621 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2622 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2623 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2624 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2626 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2627 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2628 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2629 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2631 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2632 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2633 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2634 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2636 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2637 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2642 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2643 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2644 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2650 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2651 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2652 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2653 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2654 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2655 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2656 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2657 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2660 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2661 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2662 . creates a man page for the options.
2663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2666 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2673 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2674 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2675 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2676 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2679 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2680 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2681 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2684 .vitem &%--version%&
2685 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2686 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2689 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2691 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2692 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2693 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2694 clean; it ignores this option.
2699 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2700 .cindex "queue runner"
2701 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2702 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2703 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2705 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2706 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2707 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2708 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2710 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2711 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2712 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2713 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2715 When a listening daemon
2716 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2717 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2718 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2719 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2720 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2721 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2724 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2725 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2726 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2730 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2731 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2732 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2733 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2734 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2735 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2736 because these are reread each time they are used.
2740 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2741 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2745 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2746 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2747 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2748 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2749 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2750 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2752 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2753 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2754 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2755 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2756 test data. A line history is supported.
2758 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2759 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2760 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2761 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2762 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2763 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2764 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2766 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2767 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2768 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2769 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2771 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2776 of a file. For example:
2778 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2780 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2781 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2782 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2783 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2784 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2785 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2786 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2789 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2791 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2792 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2793 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2794 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2795 system filters are recognized.
2797 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2799 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2800 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2801 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2802 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2803 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2804 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2805 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2806 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2809 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2810 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2811 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2813 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2815 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2816 variables that are used by the user filter.
2818 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2823 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2824 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2825 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2828 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2829 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2830 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2831 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2833 When testing a filter file,
2834 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2835 .cindex "envelope sender"
2836 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2837 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2838 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2839 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2840 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2843 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2845 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2846 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2847 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2850 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2852 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2853 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2854 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2855 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2856 actually being delivered.
2858 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2860 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2861 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2864 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2866 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2867 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2870 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2872 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2873 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2874 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2875 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2876 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2877 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2878 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2879 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2880 after a full stop. For example:
2882 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2883 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2885 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2886 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2887 conversion to the canonical form is
2888 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2890 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2891 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2892 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2893 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2894 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2898 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2899 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2900 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2903 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2904 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2905 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2907 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2908 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2909 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2910 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2911 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2912 session were authenticated.
2914 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2915 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2916 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2918 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2919 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2920 specialized SMTP test program such as
2921 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2923 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2925 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2926 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2927 updating the callout cache database.
2931 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2932 .cindex "building alias file"
2933 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2934 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2935 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2936 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2937 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2940 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2941 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2942 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2943 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2944 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2945 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2950 .cindex "local message reception"
2951 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2952 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2953 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2954 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2955 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2956 if no other conflicting option is present.
2958 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2959 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2960 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2961 suppressing this for special cases.
2963 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2964 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2966 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2967 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2968 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2971 .cindex "message" "format"
2972 .cindex "format" "message"
2973 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2974 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2975 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2976 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2977 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2979 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2980 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2982 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2983 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2984 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2985 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2986 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2988 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2989 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2990 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2991 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2992 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2994 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
2995 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
2996 .cindex "testing", "malware"
2997 .cindex "malware scan test"
2998 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
2999 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3000 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3001 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3002 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3003 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3005 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3006 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3007 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3008 This option requires admin privileges.
3010 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3011 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3012 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3016 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3017 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3018 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3019 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3020 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3021 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3022 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3024 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3025 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3026 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3027 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3028 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3030 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3031 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3032 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3033 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3038 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3039 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3040 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3041 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3042 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3043 arguments, for example:
3045 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3047 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3048 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3049 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3050 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3051 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3052 users, the output is as in this example:
3054 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3056 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3057 configuration file is output.
3058 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3059 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3061 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3062 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3063 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3064 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3065 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3066 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3067 written directly into the spool directory.
3069 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3071 exim -bP +local_domains
3073 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3074 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3076 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3077 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3078 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3079 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3080 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3081 that driver are output. For example:
3083 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3085 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3086 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3087 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3088 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3089 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3092 .cindex "environment"
3093 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3094 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag supresses the value of the
3097 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3098 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3099 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3100 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3101 The output format is one item per line.
3105 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3106 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3107 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3108 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3109 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3110 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3111 to allow any user to see the queue.
3113 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3115 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3116 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3119 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3120 .cindex "size" "of message"
3121 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3122 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3123 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3124 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3125 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3126 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3127 before the sender address.
3129 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3130 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3131 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3133 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3134 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3135 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3136 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3137 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3143 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3144 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3145 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3151 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3152 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3153 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3154 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3159 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3160 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3161 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3162 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3166 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3170 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3175 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3176 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3177 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3178 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3183 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3184 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3185 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3186 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3187 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3189 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3190 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3192 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3193 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3194 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3195 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3196 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3197 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3198 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3199 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3200 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3202 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3203 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3208 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3209 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3210 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3211 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3212 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3213 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3214 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3218 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3219 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3220 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3221 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3222 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3223 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3224 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3225 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3226 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3228 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3229 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3230 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3232 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3233 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3234 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3235 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3237 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3238 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3239 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3241 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3242 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3243 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3244 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3245 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3247 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3248 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3252 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3253 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3254 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3255 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3256 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3257 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3258 messages to the MTA.
3261 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3262 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3263 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3264 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3265 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3266 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3267 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3271 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3272 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3273 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3274 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3275 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3276 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3277 the listening daemon.
3281 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3282 .cindex "address" "testing"
3283 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3284 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3285 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3286 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3287 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3289 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3290 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3292 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3293 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3296 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3297 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3298 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3299 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3300 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3303 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3304 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3305 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3306 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3308 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3309 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3310 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3311 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3314 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3315 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3317 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3318 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3319 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3320 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3321 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3322 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3327 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3328 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3329 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3330 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3331 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3332 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3334 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3335 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3336 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3337 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3338 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3339 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3340 dynamic testing facilities.
3344 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3345 .cindex "address" "verification"
3346 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3347 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3348 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3349 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3350 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3351 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3353 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3354 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3355 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3357 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3358 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3360 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3361 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3364 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3365 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3366 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3367 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3368 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3370 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3371 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3372 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3373 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3374 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3375 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3378 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3379 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3380 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3383 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3384 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3385 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3386 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3388 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3389 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3390 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3391 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3395 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3396 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3403 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3404 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3405 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3406 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3408 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3409 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3410 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3411 each port only when the first connection is received.
3413 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3414 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3416 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3418 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3419 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3420 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3421 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3422 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3423 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3424 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3425 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3426 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3428 The file names need to be absolute names.
3430 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3431 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3432 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3433 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3434 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3435 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3436 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3437 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3438 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3440 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3441 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3442 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3443 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3444 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3445 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3446 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3448 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3449 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3450 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3451 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3452 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3453 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3454 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3456 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3457 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3458 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3461 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3462 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3463 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3464 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3465 specified by this option.
3468 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3470 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3471 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3472 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3473 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3474 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3475 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3477 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3478 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3479 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3480 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3481 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3482 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3483 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3485 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3486 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3487 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3493 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3494 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3497 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3499 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3502 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3504 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3505 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3506 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3507 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3508 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3509 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3510 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3513 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3514 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3515 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3516 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3517 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3518 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3519 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3522 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3523 &`auth `& authenticators
3524 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3525 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3526 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3527 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3528 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3529 &`filter `& filter handling
3530 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3531 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3532 &`ident `& ident lookup
3533 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3534 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3535 &`load `& system load checks
3536 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3537 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3538 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3539 &`memory `& memory handling
3540 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3541 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3542 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3543 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3544 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3545 &`retry `& retry handling
3546 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3547 &`route `& address routing
3548 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3550 &`transport `& transports
3551 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3552 &`verify `& address verification logic
3553 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3555 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3556 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3557 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3558 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3559 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3560 turn everything off.
3562 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3563 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3564 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3565 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3566 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3569 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3570 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3571 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3572 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3573 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3576 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3577 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3580 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3581 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3583 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3585 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3586 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3587 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3588 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3591 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3592 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3593 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3594 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3598 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3599 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3600 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3601 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3602 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3603 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3604 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3605 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3608 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3609 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3610 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3611 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3612 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3614 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3616 .cindex "sender" "name"
3617 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3618 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3619 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3620 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3621 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3622 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3624 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3626 .cindex "sender" "address"
3627 .cindex "address" "sender"
3628 .cindex "trusted users"
3629 .cindex "envelope sender"
3630 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3631 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3632 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3633 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3636 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3637 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3638 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3639 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3642 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3643 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3644 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3645 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3646 examples of shell commands:
3648 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3649 exim -f "" user@domain
3651 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3652 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3655 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3656 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3657 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3658 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3661 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3662 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3663 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3664 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3665 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3666 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3670 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3671 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3673 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3676 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3677 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3682 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3683 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3684 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3685 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3686 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3687 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3689 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3691 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3692 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3693 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3694 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3695 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3696 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3697 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3700 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3701 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3702 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3703 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3704 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3705 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3707 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3708 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3709 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3710 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3712 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3714 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3715 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3716 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3717 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3718 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3719 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3720 can be used only by an admin user.
3722 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3723 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3725 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3726 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3727 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3728 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3729 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3730 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3731 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3732 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3736 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3737 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3738 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3742 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3743 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3744 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3746 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3748 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3749 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3750 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3751 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3752 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3753 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3757 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3758 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3759 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3764 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3765 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3766 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3768 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3770 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3771 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3772 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3773 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3774 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3775 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3776 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3777 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3778 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3779 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3780 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3781 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3782 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3784 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3786 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3787 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3788 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3789 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3790 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3791 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3792 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3793 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3795 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3797 .cindex "freezing messages"
3798 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3799 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3800 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3801 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3802 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3803 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3806 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3808 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3809 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3810 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3811 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3812 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3813 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3814 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3815 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3818 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3820 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3821 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3822 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3823 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3824 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3826 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3828 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3829 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3830 .cindex "removing recipients"
3831 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3832 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3833 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3834 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3835 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3836 can be used only by an admin user.
3838 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3840 .cindex "removing messages"
3841 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3842 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3843 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3844 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3845 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3846 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3847 placed on the queue.
3849 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3851 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3852 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3853 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3854 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3855 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3856 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3857 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3858 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3859 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3861 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3863 .cindex "thawing messages"
3864 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3865 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3866 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3867 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3868 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3869 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3872 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3874 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3875 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3876 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3877 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3879 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3881 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3882 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3883 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3884 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3885 only by an admin user.
3887 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3889 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3890 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3891 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3892 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3893 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3895 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3897 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3898 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3899 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3900 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3904 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3905 treats it that way too.
3909 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3910 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3911 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3912 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3913 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3914 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3915 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3918 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3919 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3920 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3921 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3922 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3923 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3924 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3929 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3930 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3933 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3935 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3938 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3940 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3941 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3942 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3945 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3947 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3948 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3949 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3950 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3951 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3952 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3956 .cindex "background delivery"
3957 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3958 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3959 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3960 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3961 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3962 processes to finish.
3964 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3965 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3966 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3967 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3969 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3970 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3971 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3972 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3976 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3977 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3978 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3979 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3980 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3981 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3983 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3984 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3987 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3988 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3990 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3991 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3992 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3993 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3998 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4003 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4004 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4005 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4006 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4007 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4008 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4009 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4010 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4011 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4012 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4017 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4018 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4019 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4020 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4021 configuration file is in effect.
4023 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4024 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4025 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4026 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4027 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4028 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4029 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4030 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4031 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4036 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4037 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4038 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4041 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4043 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4044 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4045 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4046 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4050 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4051 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4052 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4053 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4054 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4058 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4059 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4060 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4061 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4062 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4066 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4067 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4072 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4073 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4078 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4079 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4080 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4081 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4082 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4083 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4086 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4087 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4089 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4091 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4092 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4093 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4094 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4095 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4096 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4098 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4099 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4101 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4103 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4104 followed by a colon and the port number:
4106 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4108 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4109 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4110 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4111 whichever one is last.
4113 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4115 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4116 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4117 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4118 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4119 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4120 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4122 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4124 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4125 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4126 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4127 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4128 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4129 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4131 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4133 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4134 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4135 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4136 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4137 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4138 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4139 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4140 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4142 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4144 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4145 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4146 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4147 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4148 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4150 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4152 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4153 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4154 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4155 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4156 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4157 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4158 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4159 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4160 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4163 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4165 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4166 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4167 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4168 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4169 uses the name it is given.
4171 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4173 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4174 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4175 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4176 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4177 used, when there is no default.
4181 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4182 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4183 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4184 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4188 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4189 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4190 whatever that means.
4192 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4194 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4195 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4196 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4197 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4198 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4199 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4200 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4202 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4204 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4205 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4206 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4207 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4208 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4210 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4212 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4213 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4214 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4215 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4216 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4217 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4221 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4223 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4225 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4226 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4227 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4228 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4229 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4230 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4231 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4232 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4236 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4237 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4238 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4239 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4244 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4245 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4246 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4247 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4250 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4252 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4254 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4256 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4257 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4258 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4259 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4260 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4264 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4265 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4266 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4267 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4268 and &%-S%& options).
4270 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4271 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4272 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4273 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4274 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4275 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4278 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4279 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4280 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4281 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4282 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4285 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4286 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4287 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4288 this to be repeated periodically.
4290 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4291 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4292 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4293 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4295 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4296 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4297 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4299 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4300 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4301 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4302 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4306 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4307 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4308 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4309 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4310 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4311 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4314 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4315 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4316 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4317 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4318 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4319 delivered down a single SMTP
4320 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4321 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4322 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4323 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4324 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4327 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4329 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4330 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4331 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4332 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4333 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4335 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4337 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4338 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4339 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4340 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4341 their retry times are tried.
4343 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4345 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4346 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4349 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4351 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4352 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4353 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4356 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4357 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4358 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4359 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4360 starting message id. For example:
4362 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4364 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4365 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4366 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4368 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4370 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4371 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4372 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4373 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4374 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4375 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4377 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4378 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4379 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4380 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4381 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4382 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4383 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4384 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4385 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4387 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4389 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4390 process every 30 minutes.
4392 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4393 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4395 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4397 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4400 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4402 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4404 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4406 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4407 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4408 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4409 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4410 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4411 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4412 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4414 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4415 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4416 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4417 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4418 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4419 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4421 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4422 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4424 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4426 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4427 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4428 applied to each queue run.
4430 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4431 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4432 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4433 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4434 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4435 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4436 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4437 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4438 address will be skipped.
4440 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4441 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4442 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4445 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4446 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4447 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4448 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4449 an arbitrary command instead.
4453 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4455 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4457 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4458 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4459 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4460 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4461 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4462 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4464 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4466 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4467 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4468 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4472 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4473 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4474 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4475 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4476 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4477 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4478 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4479 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4480 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4482 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4483 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4484 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4485 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4486 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4487 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4488 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4489 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4490 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4491 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4492 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4494 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4495 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4496 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4497 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4498 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4499 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4501 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4502 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4503 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4504 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4505 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4506 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4507 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4508 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4509 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4513 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4514 compatibility with Sendmail.
4516 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4517 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4518 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4519 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4520 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4521 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4522 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4523 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4528 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4529 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4530 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4531 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4532 set. Exim ignores this option.
4536 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4537 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4538 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4539 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4540 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4541 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4546 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4547 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4548 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4557 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4558 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4559 . creates a man page for the options.
4560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4563 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4571 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4574 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4575 "The runtime configuration file"
4577 .cindex "run time configuration"
4578 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4579 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4580 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4581 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4582 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4583 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4584 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4585 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4588 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4589 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4590 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4591 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4592 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4593 actually alter the string.
4595 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4596 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4597 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4598 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4599 existing file in the list.
4602 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4603 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4604 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4605 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4606 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4607 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4608 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4609 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4610 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4611 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4613 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4614 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4615 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4616 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4617 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4619 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4620 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4621 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4622 compromise the Exim user account.
4624 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4625 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4626 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4627 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4628 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4629 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4634 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4635 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4636 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4637 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4638 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4639 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4640 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4641 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4642 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4643 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4644 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4646 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4647 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4648 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4649 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4650 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4651 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4652 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4653 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4654 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4657 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4658 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4659 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4660 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4661 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4663 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4664 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4665 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4666 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4667 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4668 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4670 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4671 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4672 necessarily be discarded.
4673 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4674 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4675 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4676 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4677 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4678 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4680 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4681 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4682 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4683 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4684 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4685 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4686 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4688 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4689 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4690 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4694 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4695 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4696 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4697 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4698 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4699 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4700 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4704 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4707 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4708 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4709 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4711 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4712 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4713 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4715 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4716 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4717 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4719 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4720 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4721 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4722 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4725 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4726 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4727 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4729 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4730 want to use this feature, you must set
4732 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4734 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4735 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4738 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4740 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4741 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4743 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4744 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4745 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4746 and does not introduce a comment.
4748 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4749 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4750 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4751 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4752 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4754 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4755 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4756 change settings as required.
4758 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4759 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4760 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4761 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4762 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4767 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4768 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4769 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4770 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4771 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4772 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4775 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4776 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4778 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4779 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4780 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4783 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4784 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4785 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4786 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4788 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4789 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4792 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4795 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4796 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4801 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4802 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4803 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4804 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4805 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4806 definition, and must be of the form
4808 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4810 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4811 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4812 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4813 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4814 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4816 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4817 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4818 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4820 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4821 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4822 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4823 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4824 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4825 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4826 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4829 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4830 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4832 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4833 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4834 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4835 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4836 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4837 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4840 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4841 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4842 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4847 MAC == updated value
4849 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4850 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4851 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4852 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4856 MAC == MAC and something added
4858 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4859 from a number of other files.
4861 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4862 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4863 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4864 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4865 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4870 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4871 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4872 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4873 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4875 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4876 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4878 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4880 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4882 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4883 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4884 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4887 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4888 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4889 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4890 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4891 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4892 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4893 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4895 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4896 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4897 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4901 message_size_limit = 50M
4903 message_size_limit = 100M
4906 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4907 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4908 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4909 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4911 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4912 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4913 in this line"& will always be true.
4915 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4916 to clarify complicated nestings.
4920 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4921 .cindex "common option syntax"
4922 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4923 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4924 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4925 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4926 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4927 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4928 space) and then the value. For example:
4930 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4932 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4933 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4934 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4935 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4936 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4937 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4938 word &"hide"&. For example:
4940 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4942 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4944 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4946 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4947 all instances of the same driver.
4949 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4950 that are found in option settings.
4953 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4954 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4955 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4956 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4957 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4958 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4959 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4960 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4961 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4962 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4963 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4964 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4969 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4974 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4979 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4980 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4981 .cindex "format" "integer"
4982 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4983 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4984 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4985 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4988 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4989 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4990 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4991 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4992 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4996 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4997 .cindex "integer format"
4998 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4999 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5000 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5001 Such options are always output in octal.
5004 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5005 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5006 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5007 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5008 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5012 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5013 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5014 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5015 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5016 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5026 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5027 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5028 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5032 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5033 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5034 .cindex "format" "string"
5035 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5036 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5037 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5038 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5039 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5040 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5041 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5042 therefore equivalent:
5044 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5045 trusted_users = uucp:\
5046 # This comment line is ignored
5049 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5050 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5051 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5052 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5053 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5056 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5057 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5058 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5060 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5061 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5065 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5066 character, that character replaces the pair.
5068 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5069 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5070 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5071 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5072 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5073 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5076 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5077 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5078 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5079 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5080 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5081 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5082 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5083 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5084 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5085 within a quoted configuration string.
5088 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5089 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5090 .cindex "format" "user name"
5091 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5092 .cindex "format" "group name"
5093 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5094 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5095 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5096 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5099 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5100 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5101 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5102 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5103 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5104 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5105 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5106 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5107 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5108 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5109 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5111 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5112 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5113 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5114 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5115 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5116 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5119 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5121 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5123 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5124 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5125 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5126 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5128 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5129 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5130 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5131 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5132 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5133 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5134 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5135 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5137 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5139 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5140 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5141 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5143 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5144 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5145 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5146 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5147 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5148 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5149 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5150 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5151 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5153 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5155 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5156 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5157 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5158 the value in quotes. For example:
5160 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5162 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5163 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5164 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5165 enclosing an empty list item.
5169 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5170 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5171 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5172 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5174 senders = user@domain :
5176 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5177 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5178 items, the second of which is empty:
5180 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5182 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5183 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5184 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5185 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5189 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5190 is at the end of the list.
5195 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5196 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5197 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5198 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5199 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5200 a sequence of lines like this:
5202 <&'instance name'&>:
5207 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5208 followed by three options settings:
5213 transport = local_delivery
5215 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5216 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5217 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5218 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5219 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5220 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5222 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5223 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5225 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5226 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5227 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5228 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5229 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5232 .cindex "generic options"
5233 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5234 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5235 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5236 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5237 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5238 .cindex "private options"
5239 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5240 they all have default values.
5242 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5243 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5244 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5246 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5247 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5248 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5249 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5250 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5251 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5252 configuration lines:
5257 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5258 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5259 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5260 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5266 command_timeout = 10s
5268 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5269 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5272 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5273 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5274 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5282 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5285 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5286 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5287 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5288 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5289 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5290 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5291 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5292 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5293 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5294 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5295 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5299 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5300 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5301 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5304 # primary_hostname =
5306 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5307 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5308 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5309 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5311 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5313 domainlist local_domains = @
5314 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5315 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5317 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5318 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5319 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5320 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5322 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5323 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5326 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5327 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5328 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5329 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5330 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5331 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5333 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5334 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5335 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5336 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5337 domain is permitted.
5339 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5340 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5341 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5342 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5343 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5344 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5346 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5347 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5348 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5350 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5352 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5353 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5355 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5356 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5357 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5358 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5359 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5360 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5361 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5362 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5363 contents of a message to be checked.
5365 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5367 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5368 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5370 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5371 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5372 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5373 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5375 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5377 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5378 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5379 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5381 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5382 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5383 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5384 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5385 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5386 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5387 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5389 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5391 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5392 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5394 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5395 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5396 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5397 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5398 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5399 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5400 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5401 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5402 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5403 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5404 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5405 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5406 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5407 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5408 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5409 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5411 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5414 # qualify_recipient =
5416 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5417 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5418 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5419 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5420 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5421 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5423 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5424 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5425 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5426 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5428 # allow_domain_literals
5430 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5431 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5432 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5433 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5434 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5435 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5437 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5441 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5442 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5443 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5444 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5445 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5446 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5447 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5448 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5450 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5451 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5456 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5457 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5458 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5459 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5460 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5461 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5464 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5465 1413 (hence their names):
5468 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5470 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5471 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5472 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5473 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5474 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5475 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5476 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5478 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5479 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5480 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5481 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5483 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5484 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5486 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5487 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5489 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5491 # percent_hack_domains =
5493 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5494 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5495 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5497 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5498 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5499 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5500 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5501 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5502 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5503 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5504 always bounce messages.
5506 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5507 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5509 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5510 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5511 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5512 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5513 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5517 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5518 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5519 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5520 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5521 It starts with the line
5525 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5526 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5527 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5529 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5530 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5531 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5532 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5533 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5534 result of the ACL processing.
5538 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5543 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5544 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5545 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5546 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5547 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5548 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5550 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5551 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5552 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5555 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5556 domains = +local_domains
5557 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5559 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5560 domains = !+local_domains
5561 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5563 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5564 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5565 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5566 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5567 in Internet mail addresses.
5569 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5570 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5571 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5572 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5573 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5574 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5575 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5576 policy of being as safe as possible.
5578 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5579 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5580 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5581 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5582 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5583 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5585 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5586 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5587 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5588 have to modify this rule.
5590 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5591 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5592 common convention of local parts constructed as
5593 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5594 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5595 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5596 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5597 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5598 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5600 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5601 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5602 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5603 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5604 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5605 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5606 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5608 accept local_parts = postmaster
5609 domains = +local_domains
5611 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5612 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5613 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5614 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5615 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5617 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5618 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5619 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5621 require verify = sender
5623 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5624 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5625 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5626 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5627 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5628 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5629 discusses the details of address verification.
5631 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5632 control = submission
5634 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5635 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5636 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5637 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5638 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5639 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5640 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5641 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5642 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5644 accept authenticated = *
5645 control = submission
5647 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5648 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5649 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5650 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5651 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5652 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5654 require message = relay not permitted
5655 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5657 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5658 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5660 require verify = recipient
5662 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5663 fails, the address is rejected.
5665 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5666 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5668 # dnslists = black.list.example
5670 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5671 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5672 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5673 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5675 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5676 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5677 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5680 # require verify = csa
5682 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5683 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5688 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5689 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5693 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5694 of this ACL are commented out:
5697 # message = This message contains a virus \
5700 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5701 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5702 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5703 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5705 # warn spam = nobody
5706 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5707 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5708 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5709 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5711 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5712 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5713 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5714 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5715 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5716 whatever the spam score.
5720 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5723 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5724 .cindex "default" "routers"
5725 .cindex "routers" "default"
5726 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5731 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5732 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5733 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5734 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5735 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5738 # driver = ipliteral
5739 # domains = !+local_domains
5740 # transport = remote_smtp
5742 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5743 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5744 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5745 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5746 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5750 domains = ! +local_domains
5751 transport = remote_smtp
5752 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5755 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5756 domains. This is specified by the line
5758 domains = ! +local_domains
5760 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5761 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5762 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5763 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5764 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5765 passed on to the following routers.
5767 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5768 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5769 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5770 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5771 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5773 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5774 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5775 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5776 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5777 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5778 the address fails and is bounced.
5780 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5781 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5782 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5783 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5784 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5785 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5786 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5793 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5795 file_transport = address_file
5796 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5798 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5799 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5800 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5801 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5802 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5805 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5806 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5807 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5808 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5813 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5814 # local_part_suffix_optional
5815 file = $home/.forward
5820 file_transport = address_file
5821 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5822 reply_transport = address_reply
5824 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5825 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5826 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5827 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5828 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5831 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5832 # local_part_suffix_optional
5834 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5835 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5836 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5837 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5838 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5839 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5840 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5842 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5843 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5844 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5845 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5847 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5848 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5849 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5850 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5851 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5852 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5853 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5855 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5856 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5857 There are two reasons for doing this:
5860 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5861 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5864 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5865 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5866 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5867 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5871 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5872 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5873 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5874 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5876 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5877 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5878 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5880 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5882 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5888 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5889 # local_part_suffix_optional
5890 transport = local_delivery
5892 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5893 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5894 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5895 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5896 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5899 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5900 .cindex "default" "transports"
5901 .cindex "transports" "default"
5902 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5903 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5904 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5908 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5913 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5914 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5918 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5925 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5926 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5927 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5928 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5929 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5930 show how this can be done.
5932 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5933 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5934 similarly-named options above.
5940 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5941 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5942 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5951 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5952 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5953 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5958 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5963 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5964 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5965 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5966 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5967 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5968 introduced by the line
5972 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5975 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5977 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5978 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5979 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5980 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5982 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5983 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5984 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5987 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5988 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5992 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5993 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5997 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5998 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5999 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6001 begin authenticators
6003 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6004 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6005 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6006 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6007 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6008 to support most MUA software.
6010 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6013 # driver = plaintext
6014 # server_set_id = $auth2
6015 # server_prompts = :
6016 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6017 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6019 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6022 # driver = plaintext
6023 # server_set_id = $auth1
6024 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6025 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6026 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6029 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6030 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6031 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6032 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6033 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6034 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6035 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6036 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6038 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6039 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6040 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6041 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6043 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6044 usercode and password are in different positions.
6045 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6047 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6054 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6056 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6058 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6059 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6060 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6061 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6062 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6063 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6065 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6066 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6067 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6068 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6069 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6072 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6073 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6074 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6075 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6077 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6079 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6080 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6081 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6082 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6083 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6084 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6087 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6088 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6089 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6090 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6091 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6092 match anywhere in the subject string.
6094 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6095 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6097 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6099 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6102 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6104 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6105 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6109 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6112 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6113 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6114 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6115 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6116 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6117 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6120 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6121 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6122 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6123 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6124 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6126 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6127 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6128 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6129 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6130 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6133 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6134 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6135 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6136 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6137 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6138 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6140 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6141 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6142 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6143 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6144 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6146 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6147 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6149 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6150 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6151 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6152 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6153 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6155 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6156 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6158 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6159 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6161 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6162 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6163 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6168 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6169 matches the list item.
6171 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6172 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6174 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6176 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6177 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6178 causes a second lookup to occur.
6180 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6181 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6182 lookup is permitted.
6185 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6186 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6187 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6188 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6191 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6192 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6193 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6195 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6196 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6197 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6198 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6201 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6202 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6203 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6208 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6209 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6210 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6215 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6216 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6217 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6218 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6221 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6222 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6223 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6224 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6225 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6226 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6227 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6228 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6229 be found in several places:
6231 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6232 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6233 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6235 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6236 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6237 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6238 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6240 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6241 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6242 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6243 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6244 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6245 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6246 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6248 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6249 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6250 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6251 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6252 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6253 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6254 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6257 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6258 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6260 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6261 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6262 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6263 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6264 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6265 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6266 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6269 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6270 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6271 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6273 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6274 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6275 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6276 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6277 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6278 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6279 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6280 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6281 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6282 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6284 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6285 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6286 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6287 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6288 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6289 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6290 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6291 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6292 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6294 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6295 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6296 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6297 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6298 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6299 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6300 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6302 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6303 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6304 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6305 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6307 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6308 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6309 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6310 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6311 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6313 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6314 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6315 lookup types support only literal keys.
6317 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6318 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6319 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6321 .cindex "linear search"
6322 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6323 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6324 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6325 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6326 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6327 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6328 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6329 in the file is used.
6331 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6332 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6333 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6334 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6335 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6340 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6341 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6342 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6343 wildcarding of any kind.
6345 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6346 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6347 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6348 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6349 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6350 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6351 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6352 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6353 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6356 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6357 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6358 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6359 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6360 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6361 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6362 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6363 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6366 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6367 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6368 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6369 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6370 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6371 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6372 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6373 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6374 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6376 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6377 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6378 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6379 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6381 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6382 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6385 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6387 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6388 *fish data for anythingfish
6391 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6392 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6394 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6396 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6397 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6398 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6400 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6402 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6403 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6404 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6406 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6409 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6410 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6411 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6412 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6413 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6415 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6416 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6417 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6418 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6419 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6422 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6423 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6424 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6427 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6429 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6432 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6433 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6434 be followed by optional colons.
6436 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6437 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6438 lookup types support only literal keys.
6442 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6444 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6445 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6446 many of them are given in later sections.
6449 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6450 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6451 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6452 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6453 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6455 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6456 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6457 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6459 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6460 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6461 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6462 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6463 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6464 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6465 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6467 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6468 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6469 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6470 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6472 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6474 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6475 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6477 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6478 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6479 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6480 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6482 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6483 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6484 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6485 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6486 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6487 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6488 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6489 password value. For example:
6491 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6494 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6495 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6496 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6497 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6500 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6501 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6502 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6503 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6506 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6507 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6509 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6510 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6511 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6512 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6513 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6514 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6515 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6516 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6517 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6519 require condition = \
6520 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6522 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6523 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6524 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6525 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6530 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6531 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6532 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6533 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6534 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6535 options such as a list of local domains.
6537 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6538 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6539 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6540 or may give up altogether.
6544 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6545 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6546 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6547 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6548 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6549 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6550 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6551 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6553 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6554 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6555 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6557 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6558 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6559 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6561 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6562 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6563 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6564 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6565 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6566 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6567 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6568 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6569 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6570 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6572 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6574 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6575 looks up these keys, in this order:
6581 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6582 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6583 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6584 Exim move on to try the next key.
6588 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6589 .cindex "partial matching"
6590 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6591 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6592 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6593 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6594 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6595 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6596 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6597 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6598 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6599 a key in a DBM file is
6601 *.dates.fict.example
6603 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6604 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6605 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6608 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6609 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6610 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6612 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6613 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6614 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6615 partial matching keys
6616 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6617 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6618 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6620 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6621 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6622 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6623 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6624 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6625 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6628 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6629 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6630 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6631 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6632 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6633 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6635 2250.dates.fict.example
6636 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6637 *.dates.fict.example
6640 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6643 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6644 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6645 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6646 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6647 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6648 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6650 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6652 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6653 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6654 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6655 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6657 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6659 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6660 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6662 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6663 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6664 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6667 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6669 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6670 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6672 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6673 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6674 for &"*"& on its own.
6676 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6680 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6681 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6682 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6683 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6684 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6685 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6686 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6688 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6689 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6690 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6691 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6692 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6697 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6699 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6700 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6701 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6702 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6703 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6705 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6706 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6707 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6708 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6709 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6710 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6712 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6713 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6719 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6720 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6721 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6722 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6723 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6724 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6728 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6729 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6731 [name="$local_part"]
6733 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6734 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6735 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6736 of the following form is provided:
6738 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6740 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6742 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6744 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6745 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6746 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6751 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6752 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6753 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6754 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6755 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6756 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6757 an expansion string could contain:
6759 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6761 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6762 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6763 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6764 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6767 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6768 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6769 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6770 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6771 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6774 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6776 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6777 altered and nothing is added.
6779 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6780 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6781 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6782 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6783 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6785 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6786 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6787 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6788 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6789 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6790 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6792 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6794 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6795 white space is ignored.
6797 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6798 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6800 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6801 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6802 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6803 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6804 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6807 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6808 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6809 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6811 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6812 white space is ignored.
6814 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6815 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6816 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6817 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6818 the pseudo-type MXH:
6820 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6822 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6825 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6826 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6827 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6828 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6829 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6830 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6831 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6832 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6834 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6835 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6837 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6838 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6839 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6841 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6842 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6843 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6844 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6845 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6848 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6849 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6850 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6851 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6852 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6853 result of a successful lookup such as:
6855 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6857 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6858 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6859 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6862 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6863 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6864 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6865 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6866 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6868 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6869 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6870 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6872 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6873 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6874 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6875 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6877 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6878 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6879 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6881 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6882 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6883 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6884 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6885 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6886 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6887 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6888 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6889 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6890 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6892 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6893 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6895 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6896 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6901 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6902 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6903 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6904 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6905 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6906 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6907 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6908 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6909 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6910 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6911 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6912 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6914 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6915 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6916 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6917 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6918 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6920 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6921 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6923 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6924 the way they handle the results of a query:
6927 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6930 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6931 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6933 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6934 from all of them are returned.
6938 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6939 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6940 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6941 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6944 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6945 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6946 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6947 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6949 data = ${lookup ldap \
6950 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6951 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6953 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6954 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6955 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6956 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6958 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
6959 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
6960 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
6963 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6964 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6965 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6966 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6967 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6968 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6970 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6971 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6979 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6980 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6984 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6986 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6990 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6992 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6994 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6996 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6997 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6998 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7002 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7003 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7004 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7006 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7010 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7012 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7014 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7016 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7017 authentication below.
7020 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7021 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7022 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7023 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7024 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7027 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7029 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7030 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7031 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7032 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7033 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7034 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7035 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7036 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7037 failures, and timeouts.
7039 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7040 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7041 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7042 doubled. For example
7044 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7046 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7047 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7048 the local host) is used.
7050 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7051 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7052 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7053 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7056 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7057 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7058 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7059 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7061 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7063 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7064 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7066 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7068 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7069 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7070 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7071 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7072 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7073 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7074 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7077 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7078 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7079 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7082 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7085 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7089 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7090 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7094 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7095 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7096 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7097 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7098 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7099 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7100 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7101 them. The following names are recognized:
7103 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7104 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7105 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7106 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7107 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7108 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7109 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7111 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7112 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7113 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7114 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7116 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7117 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7118 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7119 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7120 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7121 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7122 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7123 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7124 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7126 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7127 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7130 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7131 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7134 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7135 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7138 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7139 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7140 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7141 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7143 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7144 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7145 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7147 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7148 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7149 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7150 quoting has two advantages:
7153 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7154 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7156 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7159 For example, a setting such as
7161 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7163 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7165 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7166 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7167 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7168 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7172 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7173 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7178 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7179 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7180 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7181 as a sequence of values, for example
7183 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7185 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7186 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7187 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7188 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7189 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7192 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7193 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7194 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7196 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7197 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7198 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7199 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7200 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7201 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7202 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7204 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7205 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7206 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7208 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7211 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7214 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7215 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7217 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7218 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7220 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7221 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7222 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7223 results of LDAP lookups.
7228 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7229 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7230 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7231 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7232 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7233 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7234 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7235 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7237 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7239 might return the string
7241 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7242 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7244 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7246 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7252 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7253 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7254 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7258 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7259 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7260 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7261 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7262 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7263 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7264 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7265 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7266 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7267 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7268 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7269 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7272 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7275 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7276 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7278 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7283 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7285 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7286 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7287 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7291 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7292 with a newline between the data for each row.
7295 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7296 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7297 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7298 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7299 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7300 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7301 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7302 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7303 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7304 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7305 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7306 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7308 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7309 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7310 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7311 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7312 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7313 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7315 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7317 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7318 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7319 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7321 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7322 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7324 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7325 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7326 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7327 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7328 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7329 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7331 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7332 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7333 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7334 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7335 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7336 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7337 characters are not special.
7339 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7340 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7341 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7342 done by starting the query with
7344 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7346 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7348 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7349 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7350 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7353 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7355 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7356 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7357 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7359 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7360 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7361 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7364 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7368 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7370 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7372 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7373 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7374 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7376 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7380 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7381 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7382 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7383 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7384 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7386 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7387 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7389 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7390 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7392 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7395 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7396 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7398 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7399 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7400 is zero because no rows are affected.
7403 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7404 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7405 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7406 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7407 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7410 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7412 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7413 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7414 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7416 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7417 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7420 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7421 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7422 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7423 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7424 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7425 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7426 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7427 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7428 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7430 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7431 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7433 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7435 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7436 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7438 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7439 quote, which it doubles.
7441 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7442 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7443 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7444 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7445 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7446 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7455 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7456 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7457 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7458 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7459 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7460 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7461 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7462 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7463 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7465 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7466 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7467 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7468 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7472 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7473 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7474 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7475 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7476 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7477 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7478 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7479 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7482 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7483 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7484 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7486 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7487 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7488 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7489 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7490 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7492 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7493 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7495 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7496 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7497 senders based on the receiving domain.
7502 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7503 .cindex "list" "negation"
7504 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7505 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7506 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7507 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7508 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7509 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7511 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7512 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7513 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7514 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7515 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7517 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7519 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7520 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7521 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7523 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7525 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7526 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7527 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7529 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7530 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7535 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7536 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7537 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7538 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7539 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7540 file names are not allowed,
7541 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7542 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7546 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7547 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7549 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7550 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7551 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7553 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7557 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7558 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7559 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7560 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7562 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7563 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7565 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7567 and the file contains the lines
7572 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7573 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7577 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7578 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7579 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7580 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7581 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7582 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7583 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7584 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7586 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7587 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7588 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7589 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7594 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7595 .cindex "named lists"
7596 .cindex "list" "named"
7597 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7598 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7599 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7600 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7601 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7602 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7603 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7605 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7607 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7608 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7609 configured with the line
7611 domains = +local_domains
7613 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7614 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7618 domains = ! +local_domains
7619 transport = remote_smtp
7622 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7623 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7624 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7625 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7627 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7628 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7630 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7632 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7633 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7634 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7636 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7637 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7638 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7640 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7641 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7643 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7644 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7645 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7647 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7649 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7650 referenced lists if you can.
7652 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7653 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7654 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7656 domains = +local_domains
7658 on several of your routers
7659 or in several ACL statements,
7660 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7661 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7662 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7663 the same each time they are referenced.
7665 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7666 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7667 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7668 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7672 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7673 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7674 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7675 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7676 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7679 ALIST = host1 : host2
7680 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7682 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7684 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7686 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7689 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7690 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7692 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7694 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7698 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7699 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7700 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7701 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7702 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7703 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7704 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7705 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7706 message. For example:
7708 domainlist special_domains = \
7709 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7711 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7712 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7713 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7714 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7715 same list each time.
7717 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7718 cache the result anyway. For example:
7720 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7722 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7723 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7727 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7728 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7729 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7730 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7731 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7734 .cindex "primary host name"
7735 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7736 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7737 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7738 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7739 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7740 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7741 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7742 differ only in their names.
7744 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7745 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7746 .cindex "domain literal"
7747 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7748 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7749 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7750 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7751 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7752 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7755 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7756 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7757 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7758 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7759 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7760 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7761 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7762 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7763 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7764 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7765 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7767 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7768 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7769 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7770 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7771 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7773 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7774 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7775 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7776 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7777 on a router). For example:
7779 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7781 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7782 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7784 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7785 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7786 contain negative items.
7788 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7789 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7790 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7792 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7793 an.other.domain : ...
7795 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7796 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7798 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7799 an.other.domain ? ...
7802 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7803 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7804 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7805 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7806 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7807 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7808 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7809 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7810 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7814 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7815 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7816 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7817 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7818 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7819 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7820 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7821 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7822 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7824 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7825 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7826 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7827 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7828 expression by expansion, of course).
7830 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7831 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7832 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7833 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7834 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7835 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7837 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7839 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7840 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7841 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7842 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7843 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7844 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7845 other statements in the same ACL.
7848 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7849 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7851 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7853 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7854 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7857 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7858 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7859 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7860 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7861 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7862 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7865 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7866 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7867 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7868 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7870 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7871 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7873 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7874 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7875 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7876 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7877 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7879 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7880 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7881 between the pattern and the domain.
7884 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7886 domainlist funny_domains = \
7889 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7890 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7891 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7892 nis;domains.byname : \
7893 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7895 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7896 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7897 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7898 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7899 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7904 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7905 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7906 .cindex "list" "host list"
7907 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7908 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7909 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7910 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7911 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7912 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7913 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7916 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7917 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7918 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7919 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7920 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7921 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7924 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7925 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7926 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7930 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7931 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7932 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7933 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7934 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7935 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7936 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7939 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7940 inspecting its IP address:
7943 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7944 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7945 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7946 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7947 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7948 with the IP address of the subject host.
7950 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7951 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7952 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7953 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7954 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7957 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7958 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7959 domain name, as just described.
7962 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7963 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7964 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7965 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7966 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7967 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7968 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7969 that can never match a client host.
7972 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7973 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7974 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7975 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7977 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7981 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7982 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7983 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7984 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7985 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7986 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7987 significant end of the address.
7989 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7990 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7991 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7992 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7996 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7997 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8000 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8002 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8003 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8005 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8006 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8009 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8011 could make use of a file containing
8016 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8017 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8018 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8020 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8023 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8029 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8030 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8031 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8032 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8033 address, the pattern takes this form:
8035 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8039 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8041 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8042 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8043 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8044 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8045 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8046 returned by the lookup is not used.
8048 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8049 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8050 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8051 patterns of this form:
8053 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8057 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8059 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8060 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8061 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8062 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8063 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8065 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8066 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8067 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8068 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8069 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8070 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8071 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8072 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8073 addresses are always used.
8075 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8076 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8077 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8080 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8081 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8082 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8083 case the IP address is used on its own.
8087 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8088 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8089 .cindex "unknown host name"
8090 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8091 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8092 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8093 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8094 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8097 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8098 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8099 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8100 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8101 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8102 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8103 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8105 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8106 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8108 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8109 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8110 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8111 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8112 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8113 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8114 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8115 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8116 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8118 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8119 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8121 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8122 .cindex "alias for host"
8123 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8124 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8127 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8128 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8129 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8130 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8131 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8134 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8135 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8136 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8137 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8138 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8139 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8140 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8145 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8146 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8147 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8148 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8149 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8151 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8153 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8154 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8155 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8162 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8163 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8164 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8165 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8166 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8167 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8169 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8170 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8172 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8173 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8174 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8175 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8176 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8177 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8180 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8181 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8183 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8185 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8186 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8189 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8190 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8193 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8196 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8197 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8198 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8201 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8202 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8206 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8208 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8209 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8210 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8211 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8212 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8213 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8214 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8215 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8216 host lists such as whitelists.
8220 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8221 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8222 .cindex "unknown host name"
8223 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8224 If a pattern is of the form
8226 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8230 dbm;/host/accept/list
8232 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8233 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8236 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8237 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8238 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8239 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8240 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8241 lookup, both using the same file.
8245 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8246 If a pattern is of the form
8248 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8250 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8251 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8252 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8254 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8255 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8257 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8258 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8259 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8262 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8263 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8264 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8266 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8267 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8268 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8269 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8270 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8271 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8275 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8277 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8278 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8279 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8282 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8284 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8285 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8286 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8287 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8288 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8289 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8291 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8292 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8294 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8295 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8297 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8298 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8304 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8305 .cindex "list" "address list"
8306 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8307 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8308 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8309 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8310 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8311 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8312 using this option setting:
8316 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8317 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8318 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8319 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8321 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8324 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8326 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8327 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8328 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8329 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8330 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8331 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8332 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8334 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8335 *@+hostile_domains:\
8336 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8337 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8339 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8340 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8341 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8342 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8343 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8345 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8346 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8347 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8348 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8349 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8351 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8354 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8355 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8359 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8360 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8361 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8362 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8363 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8364 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8365 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8367 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8368 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8370 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8371 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8374 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8375 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8376 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8379 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8380 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8381 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8383 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8384 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8385 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8386 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8388 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8389 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8391 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8392 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8393 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8394 default. For example, with this lookup:
8396 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8398 the file could contains lines like this:
8400 user1@domain1.example
8403 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8406 nimrod@jaeger.example
8410 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8411 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8413 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8415 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8416 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8418 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8419 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8420 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8424 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8425 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8430 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8431 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8432 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8433 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8434 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8435 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8436 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8437 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8438 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8440 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8441 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8442 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8443 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8444 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8447 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8449 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8451 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8453 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8455 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8456 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8457 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8458 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8459 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8460 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8462 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8465 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8468 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8469 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8470 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8471 might have entries like
8473 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8474 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8477 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8478 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8479 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8480 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8482 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8483 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8484 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8487 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8488 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8489 can only return a single list of local parts.
8492 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8493 in these two examples:
8496 senders = *@+my_list
8498 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8499 example it is a named domain list.
8504 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8505 .cindex "case of local parts"
8506 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8507 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8508 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8509 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8510 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8511 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8512 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8513 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8516 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8517 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8518 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8519 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8520 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8521 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8522 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8525 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8526 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8527 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8528 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8529 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8530 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8531 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8532 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8536 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8537 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8538 .cindex "local part" "list"
8539 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8540 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8541 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8542 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8543 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8544 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8545 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8546 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8548 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8549 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8550 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8551 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8552 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8553 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8554 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8556 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8564 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8565 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8566 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8567 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8569 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8570 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8571 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8572 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8573 escape character, as described in the following section.
8575 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8576 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8577 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8578 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8579 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8584 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8585 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8586 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8587 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8588 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8589 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8590 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8591 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8593 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8594 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8595 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8596 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8598 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8600 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8601 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8606 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8607 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8608 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8609 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8610 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8611 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8612 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8615 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8616 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8617 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8620 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8621 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8622 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8624 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8625 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8626 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8627 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8628 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8629 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8630 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8633 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8634 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8635 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8638 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8639 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8640 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8641 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8643 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8645 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8646 Exim message identifier. For example:
8648 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8650 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8651 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8654 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8655 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8656 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8657 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8658 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8659 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8660 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8661 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8662 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8663 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8664 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8665 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8671 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8672 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8673 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8674 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8675 white space is significant.
8678 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8679 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8680 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8685 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8686 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8687 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8688 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8689 given, the expansion fails.
8691 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8692 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8693 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8694 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8698 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8699 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8700 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8701 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8702 string easier to understand.
8704 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8705 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8706 expansion item below.
8708 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8709 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8711 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8712 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8716 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8717 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8718 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8720 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8721 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8722 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8723 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8724 must have the following type:
8726 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8728 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8729 function should return one of the following values:
8731 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8732 into the expanded string that is being built.
8734 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8735 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8737 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8738 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8740 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8742 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8743 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8744 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8746 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8747 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8748 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8749 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8750 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8751 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8752 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8755 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8758 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8759 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8760 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8761 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8762 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8763 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8764 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8765 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8766 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8768 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8769 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8770 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8773 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8774 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8776 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8777 appear, for example:
8779 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8781 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8782 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8785 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8786 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8787 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8788 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8789 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8790 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8791 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8792 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8793 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8794 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8795 <&'string3'&> as before.
8797 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8798 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8799 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8800 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8801 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8802 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8803 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8804 provided. For example:
8806 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8810 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8812 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8813 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8816 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8817 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8818 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8820 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8821 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8822 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8823 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8824 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8825 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8826 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8828 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8830 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8831 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8834 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8835 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8836 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8837 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8838 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8839 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8841 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8842 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8843 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8844 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8846 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8848 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8849 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8850 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8851 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8852 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8854 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8856 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8857 letters appear. For example:
8859 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8860 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8861 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8864 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8865 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8866 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8867 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8868 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8869 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8870 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8871 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8872 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8873 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8874 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8875 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8876 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8877 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8881 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8882 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8883 lines) may be present.
8885 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8886 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8889 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8890 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8891 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8894 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8895 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8896 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8897 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8898 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8899 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8900 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8901 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8904 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8905 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8906 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8907 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8908 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8909 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8912 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8913 command of the following form:
8915 headers charset "UTF-8"
8917 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8918 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8919 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8920 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8921 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8924 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8925 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8926 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8927 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8929 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8930 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8931 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8932 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8933 router or transport are not accessible.
8935 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8936 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8937 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8938 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8939 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8940 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8942 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8943 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8944 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8945 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8946 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8947 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8948 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8950 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8951 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8952 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8953 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8954 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8955 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8956 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8957 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8960 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8961 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8963 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8964 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8965 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8966 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8967 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8968 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8969 present. For example:
8971 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8973 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8976 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8978 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8979 an Exim configuration:
8981 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8983 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8986 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8987 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8988 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8990 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8991 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8992 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8993 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8994 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8995 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8998 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8999 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9000 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9001 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9002 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9003 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9005 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9007 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9008 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9009 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9010 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9011 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9013 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9014 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9015 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9017 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9021 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9024 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9025 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9026 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9027 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9028 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9029 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9030 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9033 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9035 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9036 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9037 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9040 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9041 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9042 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9043 described in the next item.
9045 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9046 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9047 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9048 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9049 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9050 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9051 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9052 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9053 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9055 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9056 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9057 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9058 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9059 out by the system administrator.
9062 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9063 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9064 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9065 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9066 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9067 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9068 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9069 original lookup fails.
9071 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9072 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9073 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9074 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9075 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9076 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9077 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9078 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9080 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9081 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9082 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9083 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9085 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9086 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9087 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9088 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9090 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9092 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9094 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9095 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9097 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9102 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9103 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9105 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9106 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9107 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9108 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9109 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9110 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9112 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9114 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9115 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9116 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9118 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9119 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9120 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9121 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9122 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9123 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9124 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9126 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9128 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9129 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9130 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9131 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9134 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9136 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9140 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9141 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9142 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9143 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9144 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9145 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9146 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9147 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9149 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9150 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9151 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9152 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9153 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9156 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9157 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9158 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9160 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9161 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9164 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9165 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9166 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9167 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9168 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9169 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9170 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9171 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9173 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9174 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9175 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9176 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9177 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9178 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9179 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9180 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9181 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9182 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9184 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9185 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9186 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9187 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9189 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9190 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9191 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9192 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9193 is the expansion of the third argument.
9195 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9196 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9197 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9199 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9200 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9201 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9202 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9203 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9204 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9205 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9206 newlines are left in the string.
9207 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9208 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9209 the string expansion fails.
9211 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9212 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9216 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9217 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9218 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9219 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9220 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9221 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9222 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9225 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9226 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9228 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9229 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9230 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9231 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9232 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9235 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9237 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9238 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9239 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9240 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9241 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9242 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9244 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9246 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9247 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9248 turns them into spaces:
9250 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9252 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9253 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9254 addition, the following errors can occur:
9257 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9259 Failure to connect the socket;
9261 Failure to write the request string;
9263 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9266 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9267 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9268 errors occurs. For example:
9270 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9273 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9274 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9275 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9276 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9277 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9279 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9280 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9283 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9284 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9285 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9288 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9289 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9290 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9291 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9292 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9293 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9294 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9295 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9296 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9298 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9300 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9303 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9305 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9306 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9309 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9310 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9311 expansion item above.
9313 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9314 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9315 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9316 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9317 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9318 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9319 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9320 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9322 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9323 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9324 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9326 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9327 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9328 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9329 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9330 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9333 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9334 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9335 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9336 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9339 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9340 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9342 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9343 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9347 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9348 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9351 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9352 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9353 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9354 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9356 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9357 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9360 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9361 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9362 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9363 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9364 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9365 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9366 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9367 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9369 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9371 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9372 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9373 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9375 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9377 yields &"defabc"&, and
9379 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9381 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9382 the regular expression from string expansion.
9386 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9387 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9388 .cindex "substring extraction"
9389 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9390 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9391 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9392 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9393 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9395 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9397 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9398 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9401 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9402 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9403 length required. For example
9405 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9407 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9408 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9409 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9410 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9412 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9413 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9414 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9416 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9418 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9419 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9420 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9422 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9424 yields an empty string, but
9426 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9430 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9431 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9432 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9433 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9436 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9438 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9442 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9443 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9444 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9445 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9446 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9447 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9448 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9449 replacement list. For example
9451 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9453 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9454 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9455 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9461 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9462 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9463 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9464 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9465 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9466 following operations can be performed:
9469 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9470 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9471 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9472 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9473 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9474 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9477 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9478 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9479 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9480 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9481 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9482 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9483 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9484 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9485 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9487 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9488 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9489 character. For example:
9491 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9493 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9494 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9495 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9499 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9500 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9501 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9502 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9503 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9504 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9505 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9506 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9507 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9509 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9510 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9511 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9512 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9513 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9514 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9517 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9518 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9519 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9520 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9521 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9524 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9525 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9526 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9527 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9528 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9529 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9530 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9533 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9534 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9535 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9536 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9537 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9538 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9539 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9540 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9541 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9542 C programming language):
9544 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9545 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9546 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9547 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9550 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9552 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9553 space is permitted before or after operators.
9555 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9556 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9557 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9558 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9559 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9561 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9563 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9564 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9567 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9568 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9569 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9570 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9571 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9572 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9573 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9574 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9575 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9576 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9577 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9580 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9582 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9585 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9588 {$recipients_count} \
9589 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9593 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9594 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9597 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9598 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9599 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9602 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9604 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9605 and then re-expands what it has found.
9608 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9610 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9611 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9612 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9613 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9614 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9615 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9616 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9617 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9618 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9620 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9621 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9622 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9623 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9624 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9625 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9626 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9629 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9630 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9631 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9632 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9633 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9634 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9636 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9638 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9639 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9643 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9644 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9645 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9646 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9647 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9648 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9651 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9652 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9653 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9654 .cindex "lower casing"
9655 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9656 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9657 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9662 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9663 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9664 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9665 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9666 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9667 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9669 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9671 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9672 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9673 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9676 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9677 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9678 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9679 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9680 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9684 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9685 .cindex "masked IP address"
9686 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9687 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9688 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9689 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9690 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9691 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9692 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9693 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9694 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9696 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9698 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9699 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9700 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9701 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9703 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9707 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9709 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9712 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9714 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9715 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9716 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9717 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9720 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9721 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9722 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9723 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9724 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9725 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9727 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9729 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9732 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9733 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9734 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9735 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9736 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9737 is an empty string or
9738 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9739 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9740 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9741 respectively For example,
9749 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9750 variable or a message header.
9752 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9753 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9754 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9755 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9756 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9757 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9758 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9761 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9762 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9763 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9764 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9765 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9767 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9773 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9774 yields an unchanged string.
9777 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9778 .cindex "random number"
9779 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9780 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9781 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9782 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9784 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9785 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9787 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9788 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9792 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9793 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9794 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9795 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9796 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9797 for DNS. For example,
9799 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9800 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9805 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9809 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9810 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9811 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9812 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9813 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9814 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9815 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9816 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9817 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9820 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9822 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9823 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9827 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9828 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9829 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9830 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9831 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9832 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9833 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9834 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9836 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9837 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9838 to use this operator as well.
9842 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9843 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9844 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9845 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9846 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9847 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9848 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9851 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9852 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9853 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9854 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9855 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9856 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9859 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9860 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9861 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9862 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9863 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9864 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9865 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9866 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9867 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9868 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9869 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9870 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9871 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9873 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9874 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9875 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9877 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9878 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9879 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9880 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9881 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9885 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9886 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9887 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9888 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9889 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9890 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9893 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9894 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9895 .cindex "substring extraction"
9896 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9897 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9898 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9899 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9901 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9903 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9904 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9906 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9907 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9908 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9909 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9912 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9913 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9914 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9915 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9916 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9917 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9920 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9921 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9922 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9923 .cindex "upper casing"
9924 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9925 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9926 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9934 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9935 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9936 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9937 while expanding strings:
9940 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9941 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9942 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9943 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9946 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9947 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9948 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9949 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9955 &`>= `& greater or equal
9957 &`<= `& less or equal
9961 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9963 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9964 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9965 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9966 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9967 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9970 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
9971 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
9972 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
9975 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9976 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9977 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9978 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9979 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9980 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9982 An empty string is treated as false.
9983 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
9984 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
9985 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9987 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9988 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9991 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9995 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9996 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9997 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9998 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9999 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10000 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10001 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10002 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10004 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10006 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10007 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10008 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10009 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10010 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10011 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10012 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10013 included in the binary.
10015 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10016 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10017 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10018 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10019 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10020 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10021 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10022 string in LDAP form is:
10024 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10026 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10027 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10029 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10031 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10036 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10037 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10038 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10039 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10040 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10041 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10045 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10046 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10047 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10048 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10049 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10050 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10053 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10054 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10055 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10056 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10057 whatever its length.
10060 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10061 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10062 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10063 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10065 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10066 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10067 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10068 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10069 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10070 support &[crypt16()]&.
10072 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10073 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10074 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10075 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10076 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10078 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10079 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10080 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10082 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10083 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10084 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10085 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10086 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10088 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10089 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10090 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10091 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10092 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10093 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10095 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10097 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10098 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10100 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10101 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10102 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10103 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10104 exists in the message. For example,
10106 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10108 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10109 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10111 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10112 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10113 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10114 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10115 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10116 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10117 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10118 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10119 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10121 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10122 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10123 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10124 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10125 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10126 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10127 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10128 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10130 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10131 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10132 .cindex "first delivery"
10133 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10134 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10135 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10136 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10139 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10140 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10141 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10142 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10143 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10145 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10146 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10147 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10148 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10149 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10151 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10152 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10153 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10155 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10156 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10157 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10159 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10160 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10161 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10162 list separator is changed to a comma:
10164 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10166 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10167 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10170 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10171 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10172 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10173 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10174 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10175 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10176 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10177 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10178 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10181 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10182 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10183 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10184 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10185 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10186 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10187 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10188 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10189 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10193 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10194 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10195 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10196 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10197 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10198 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10201 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10202 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10204 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10205 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10206 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10207 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10211 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10212 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10213 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10214 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10215 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10216 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10217 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10218 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10219 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10220 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10221 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10223 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10224 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10225 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10226 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10227 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10229 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10230 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10231 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10232 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10234 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10236 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10238 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10239 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10240 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10241 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10242 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10243 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10244 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10245 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10246 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10247 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10248 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10249 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10250 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10254 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10255 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10256 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10257 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10258 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10259 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10260 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10261 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10262 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10265 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10266 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10267 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10268 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10269 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10270 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10271 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10272 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10273 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10277 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10279 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10280 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10281 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10282 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10283 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10284 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10285 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10286 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10287 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10290 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10292 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10293 backslashes is also required.
10295 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10296 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10297 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10298 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10299 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10300 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10302 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10303 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10304 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10305 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10306 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10307 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10308 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10309 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10311 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10312 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10313 See &*match_local_part*&.
10315 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10316 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10317 See &*match_local_part*&.
10319 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10320 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10322 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10323 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10324 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10325 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10328 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10330 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10333 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10335 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10337 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10338 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10339 in a single test such as
10340 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10341 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10342 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10343 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10345 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10347 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10349 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10351 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10352 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10353 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10354 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10355 masks. For example:
10357 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10359 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10360 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10361 address mask, for example:
10363 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10365 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10366 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10368 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10373 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10374 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10377 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10379 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10380 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10381 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10382 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10383 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10384 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10385 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10386 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10389 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10391 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10392 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10393 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10394 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10396 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10398 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10399 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10400 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10401 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10405 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10406 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10409 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10410 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10411 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10412 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10414 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10415 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10416 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10417 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10418 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10419 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10420 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10421 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10422 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10423 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10424 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10428 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10429 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10431 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10432 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10433 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10434 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10435 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10436 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10437 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10439 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10440 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10441 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10442 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10443 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10445 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10447 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10449 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10451 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10452 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10453 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10454 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10455 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10456 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10457 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10458 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10461 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10462 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10464 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10465 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10466 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10467 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10468 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10469 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10471 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10472 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10473 building Exim. For example:
10475 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10477 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10478 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10479 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10480 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10482 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10483 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10484 configuration, you might have this:
10486 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10488 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10490 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10492 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10493 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10494 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10495 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10496 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10497 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10500 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10502 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10503 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10504 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10505 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10506 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10509 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10510 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10511 this library, you need to set
10513 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10515 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10516 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10518 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10520 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10521 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10522 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10524 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10525 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10526 the authentication is successful. For example:
10528 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10532 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10533 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10534 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10537 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10538 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10539 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10540 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10541 by a process that is not running as root.
10543 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10544 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10545 building Exim. For example:
10547 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10549 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10550 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10551 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10553 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10554 two are mandatory. For example:
10556 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10558 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10559 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10560 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10565 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10566 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10567 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10568 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10569 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10570 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10571 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10575 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10576 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10577 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10578 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10579 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10582 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10584 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10585 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10586 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10588 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10589 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10590 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10591 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10592 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10593 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10594 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10595 parsed but not evaluated.
10597 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10602 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10603 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10604 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10605 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10606 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10609 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10610 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10611 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10612 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10613 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10614 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10615 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10616 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10617 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10618 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10619 matching condition.
10621 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10622 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10623 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10624 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10625 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10626 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10627 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10628 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10629 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10630 during subsequent delivery.
10632 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10633 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10634 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10635 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10636 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10637 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10638 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10639 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10642 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10643 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10644 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10645 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10646 be preserved by coding like this:
10648 warn !verify = sender
10649 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10651 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10652 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10655 .vitem &$address_data$&
10656 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10657 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10658 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10659 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10660 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10661 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10664 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10665 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10666 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10667 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10668 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10669 from the child's routing.
10671 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10672 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10673 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10676 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10677 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10678 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10680 .vitem &$address_file$&
10681 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10682 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10683 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10684 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10685 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10687 /home/r2d2/savemail
10689 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10690 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10691 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10692 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10693 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10694 to the relevant file.
10696 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10697 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10698 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10699 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10701 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10702 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10703 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10704 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10706 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10707 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10708 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10709 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10710 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10711 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10712 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10713 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10714 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10715 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10716 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10717 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10718 command line option.
10723 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10724 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10725 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10726 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10727 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10728 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10729 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10730 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10731 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10732 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10733 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10735 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10736 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10737 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10738 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10739 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10742 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10743 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10744 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10745 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10746 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10747 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10748 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10749 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10750 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10751 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10752 an undefined mechanism.
10755 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10756 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10757 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10758 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10759 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10760 the ACL malware condition.
10763 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10764 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10765 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10766 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10767 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10768 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10770 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10771 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10772 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10773 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10774 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10775 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10776 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10778 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10779 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10780 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10781 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10782 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10784 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10785 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10786 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10787 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10788 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10790 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10791 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10792 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10793 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10794 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10795 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10796 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10798 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10799 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10800 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10801 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10802 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10803 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10804 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10806 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10807 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10808 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10810 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10811 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10812 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10813 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10814 compilations of the same version of the program.
10816 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10817 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10818 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10819 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10820 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10822 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10823 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10824 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10825 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10826 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10828 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10829 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10830 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10832 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10833 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10834 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10835 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10836 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10837 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10838 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10839 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10840 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10843 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10844 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10845 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10846 case for &$domain$&.
10848 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10849 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10850 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10851 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10853 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10854 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10855 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10856 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10857 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10858 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10860 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10861 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10862 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10864 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10867 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10868 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10869 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10870 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10871 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10872 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10873 the &(smtp)& transport.
10876 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10877 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10878 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10879 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10882 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10883 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10884 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10885 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10886 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10887 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10890 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10891 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10892 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10893 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10897 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10898 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10899 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10900 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10901 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10902 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10903 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10906 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10907 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10908 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10911 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10912 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10913 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10915 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10916 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10917 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10919 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10920 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10921 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10923 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10924 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10925 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10926 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10927 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10929 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10930 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10931 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10932 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10933 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10937 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10938 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10939 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10940 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10941 by a setting on the transport itself.
10943 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10944 of the environment variable HOME.
10948 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10949 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10950 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10951 to local and remote transports.
10953 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10954 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10955 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10956 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10957 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10958 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10959 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10962 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10963 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10964 client is connected.
10967 .vitem &$host_address$&
10968 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10969 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10970 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10971 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10973 .vitem &$host_data$&
10974 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10975 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10976 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10977 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10979 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10980 message = $host_data
10982 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10983 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10984 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10985 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10986 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10987 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10988 variables is set to &"1"&.
10991 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10992 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10995 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10996 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10997 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11000 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11001 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11002 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11003 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11004 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11005 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11006 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11007 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11008 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11009 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11011 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11012 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11013 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11017 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11018 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11019 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11020 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11021 a unique name for the file.
11023 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11024 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11025 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11027 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11028 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11029 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11033 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11034 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11035 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11039 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11040 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11041 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11044 .vitem &$load_average$&
11045 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11046 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11047 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11048 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11050 .vitem &$local_part$&
11051 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11052 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11053 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11054 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11055 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11057 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11058 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11059 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11060 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11063 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11064 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11065 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11066 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11067 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11068 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11070 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11071 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11072 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11075 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11076 local part of the recipient address.
11078 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11079 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11080 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11082 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11085 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11086 abc\:xyz@test.example
11088 the value of &$local_part$& is
11092 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11093 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11096 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11098 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11099 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11100 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11102 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11103 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11104 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11105 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11106 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11107 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11108 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11110 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11111 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11112 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11113 variable expands to nothing.
11115 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11116 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11117 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11118 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11119 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11121 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11122 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11123 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11124 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11125 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11127 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11128 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11129 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11130 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11132 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11133 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11134 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11136 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11137 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11138 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11139 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11140 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11141 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11142 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11143 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11145 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11146 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11147 This contains the expanded value of the
11148 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11151 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11152 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11153 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11154 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11155 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11156 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11158 .vitem &$log_space$&
11159 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11160 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11161 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11162 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11163 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11164 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11167 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11168 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11169 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11170 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11171 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11172 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11173 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11176 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11177 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11178 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11179 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11180 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11182 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11183 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11184 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11185 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11186 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11187 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11190 .vitem &$message_age$&
11191 .cindex "message" "age of"
11192 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11193 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11194 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11197 .vitem &$message_body$&
11198 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11199 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11200 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11201 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11202 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11203 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11204 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11205 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11206 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11208 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11209 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11210 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11211 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11212 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11214 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11215 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11216 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11217 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11218 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11219 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11222 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11223 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11224 .cindex "message body" "size"
11225 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11226 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11227 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11228 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11229 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11231 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11232 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11233 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11234 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11235 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11236 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11237 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11238 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11240 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11241 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11242 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11243 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11244 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11245 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11247 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11248 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11249 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11250 contents of header lines is done.
11252 .vitem &$message_id$&
11253 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11255 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11256 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11257 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11258 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11259 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11260 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11261 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11262 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11263 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11264 from the body is not counted.
11266 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11267 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11268 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11269 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11270 header and the body).
11272 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11274 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11276 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11278 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11279 message has not yet been received.
11281 .vitem &$message_size$&
11282 .cindex "size" "of message"
11283 .cindex "message" "size"
11284 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11285 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11286 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11287 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11288 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11289 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11290 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11291 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11292 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11294 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11295 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11296 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11297 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11299 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11300 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11301 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11302 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11304 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11305 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11306 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11308 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11309 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11310 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11311 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11312 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11313 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11314 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11315 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11316 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11317 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11319 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11320 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11321 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11323 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11324 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11325 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11326 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11327 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11328 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11329 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11330 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11331 the original address.
11333 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11334 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11335 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11336 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11337 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11339 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11340 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11341 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11343 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11344 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11345 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11346 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11347 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11348 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11349 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11350 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11351 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11353 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11354 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11355 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11356 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11357 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11358 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11359 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11360 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11363 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11364 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11365 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11366 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11368 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11369 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11370 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11371 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11374 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11376 This variable contains the current process id.
11378 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11379 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11380 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11381 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11382 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11383 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11384 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11385 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11386 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11387 variable"& error if encountered.
11389 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11390 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11391 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11392 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11393 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11394 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11395 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11398 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11399 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11400 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11401 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11403 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11404 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11405 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11406 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11408 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11409 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11410 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11411 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11413 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11414 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11415 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11417 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11418 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11419 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11420 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11422 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11423 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11424 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11425 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11426 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11428 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11429 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11430 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11431 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11432 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11433 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11435 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11436 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11437 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11438 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11439 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11441 .vitem &$received_count$&
11442 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11443 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11444 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11445 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11448 .vitem &$received_for$&
11449 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11450 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11451 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11452 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11453 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11455 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11456 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11457 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11458 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11459 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11460 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11461 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11464 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11465 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11466 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11467 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11468 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11471 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11472 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11473 &(smtp)& transport).
11475 .vitem &$received_port$&
11476 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11477 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11479 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11480 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11481 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11482 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11483 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11484 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11485 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11486 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11487 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11489 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11490 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11491 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11492 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11493 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11494 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11496 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11497 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11498 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11500 .vitem &$received_time$&
11501 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11502 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11503 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11505 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11506 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11507 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11508 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11509 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11511 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11512 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11514 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11515 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11516 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11517 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11519 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11520 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11521 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11522 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11525 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11526 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11529 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11532 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11533 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11537 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11540 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11543 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11544 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11546 .vitem &$recipients$&
11547 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11548 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11549 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11550 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11551 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11555 In a system filter file.
11557 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11558 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11559 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11560 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11562 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11566 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11567 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11568 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11569 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11570 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11571 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11574 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11575 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11576 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11577 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11580 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11581 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11582 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11583 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11584 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11585 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11586 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11588 .vitem &$return_path$&
11589 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11590 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11591 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11592 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11593 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11594 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11595 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11596 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11597 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11598 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11601 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11602 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11603 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11606 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11607 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11608 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11609 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11610 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11611 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11612 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11615 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11616 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11617 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11618 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11619 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11620 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11621 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11622 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11624 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11625 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11626 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11627 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11628 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11629 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11631 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11632 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11633 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11634 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11635 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11636 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11637 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11638 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11640 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11641 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11642 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11644 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11645 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11646 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11648 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11649 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11650 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11651 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11652 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11655 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11656 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11658 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11659 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11660 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11661 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11663 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11664 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11665 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11666 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11667 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11668 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11669 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11670 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11671 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11672 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11673 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11674 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11675 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11677 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11678 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11679 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11680 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11681 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11682 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11684 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11685 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11686 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11687 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11689 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11690 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11691 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11692 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11693 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11694 &$authenticated_id$&.
11696 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11697 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11698 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11699 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11700 other means, this variable is empty.
11702 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11703 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11704 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11705 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11706 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11707 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11708 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11710 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11711 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11712 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11713 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11715 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11716 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11717 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11720 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11721 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11722 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11723 following are true:
11726 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11728 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11729 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11730 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11732 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11733 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11734 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11736 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11737 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11738 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11740 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11741 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11742 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11743 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11745 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11747 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11748 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11752 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11753 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11754 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11755 number that was used on the remote host.
11757 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11758 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11759 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11760 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11761 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11764 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11765 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11766 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11767 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11769 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11770 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11771 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11772 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11773 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11774 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11775 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11776 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11777 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11778 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11779 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11782 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11783 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11784 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11785 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11786 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11788 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11789 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11790 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11791 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11792 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11794 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11795 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11796 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11797 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11798 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11799 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11800 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11802 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11803 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11804 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11805 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11806 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11808 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11809 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11810 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11811 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11812 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11813 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11815 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11816 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11817 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11818 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11819 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11824 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11825 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11826 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11827 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11829 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11830 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11831 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11832 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11833 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11834 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11835 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11837 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11838 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11839 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11840 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11841 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11842 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11843 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11844 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11845 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11846 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11847 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11849 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11850 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11851 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11852 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11853 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11854 message is junk mail.
11856 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11857 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11858 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11859 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11862 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11863 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11864 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11866 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11867 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11868 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11869 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11870 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11871 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11873 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11874 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11875 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11876 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11877 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11878 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11879 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11880 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11882 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11884 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11887 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11888 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11889 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11890 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11891 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11892 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11895 .vitem &$tls_bits$&
11896 .vindex "&$tls_bits$&"
11897 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength; the meaning of
11898 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11899 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11900 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11901 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11904 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11905 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11906 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11907 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11909 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11910 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11911 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11912 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11913 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11914 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11915 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11916 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11918 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11919 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11920 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11921 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11922 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11923 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11925 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11926 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11927 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11928 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11929 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11930 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11931 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11936 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
11937 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
11938 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
11939 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
11940 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
11941 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
11942 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
11943 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
11944 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
11946 The value will be retained for the lifetime of the message. During outbound
11947 SMTP deliveries, it reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
11951 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11952 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11953 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11954 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11956 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11957 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11958 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11960 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
11961 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
11962 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11964 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11965 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11966 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11967 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11968 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11969 values for those that are behind (west).
11972 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11973 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11974 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11976 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11977 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11978 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11979 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11982 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11983 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11984 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11987 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11988 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11989 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11990 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11993 .vindex "&$value$&"
11994 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11995 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11996 &*reduce*& expansion.
11998 .vitem &$version_number$&
11999 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12000 The version number of Exim.
12002 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12003 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12004 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12005 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12007 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12008 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12009 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12010 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12019 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12020 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12021 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12022 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12023 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12024 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12029 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12032 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12033 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12034 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12035 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12036 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12037 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12038 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12039 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12040 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12042 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12043 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12044 should usually be something like
12046 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12048 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12049 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12050 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12051 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12052 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12053 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12054 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12055 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12059 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12060 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12061 a startup when Exim is entered.
12063 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12064 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12067 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12068 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12071 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12072 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12073 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12074 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12078 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12079 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12081 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12082 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12083 with an error message of the form
12085 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12087 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12088 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12089 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12090 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12091 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12092 that was passed to &%die%&.
12095 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12096 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12097 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12100 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12102 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12103 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12104 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12106 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12107 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12108 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12109 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12111 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12112 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12113 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12114 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12115 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12116 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12117 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12120 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12121 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12122 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12123 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12124 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12125 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12126 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12127 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12128 avoided, but the output is lost.
12130 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12131 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12132 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12133 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12134 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12135 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12136 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12138 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12140 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12141 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12142 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12143 as the first subroutine argument.
12147 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12150 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12151 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12152 "Starting the daemon"
12153 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12154 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12155 .cindex "network interface"
12156 .cindex "interface" "network"
12157 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12158 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12159 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12160 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12161 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12162 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12163 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12164 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12165 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12166 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12167 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12170 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12171 and ports to listen on.
12173 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12174 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12175 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12176 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12177 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12178 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12179 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12180 as an error situation.
12182 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12183 for the outgoing connection.
12187 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12188 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12189 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12190 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12191 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12193 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12194 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12195 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12196 chapter describes how they operate.
12198 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12199 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12203 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12204 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12205 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12209 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12210 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12212 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12213 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12216 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12217 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12218 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12219 colons. For example:
12221 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12224 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12226 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12227 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12230 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12231 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12233 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12234 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12237 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12238 with a colon separator, for example:
12240 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12241 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12245 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12246 default setting contains just one port:
12248 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12250 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12251 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12252 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12253 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12254 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12258 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12259 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12260 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12261 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12262 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12263 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12265 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12267 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12269 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12271 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12275 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12276 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12277 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12278 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12279 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12280 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12283 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12284 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12285 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12286 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12287 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12288 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12292 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12295 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12297 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12298 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12299 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12303 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12304 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12305 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12306 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12307 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12308 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12309 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12310 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12311 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12312 common use of this option is expected to be
12314 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12316 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12317 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12318 this way when a daemon is started.
12320 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12321 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12322 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12323 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12324 connections via the daemon.)
12329 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12330 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12331 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12332 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12333 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12334 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12335 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12336 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12338 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12340 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12341 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12342 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12343 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12344 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12345 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12347 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12349 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12350 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12351 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12352 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12353 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12355 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12356 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12357 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12358 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12359 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12360 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12361 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12362 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12363 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12364 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12365 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12366 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12368 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12369 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12370 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12371 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12372 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12376 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12377 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12379 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12380 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12382 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12383 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12384 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12385 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12387 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12389 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12391 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12393 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12394 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12396 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12397 IPv4 loopback address only:
12399 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12401 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12403 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12405 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12409 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12410 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12411 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12412 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12415 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12416 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12417 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12418 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12420 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12421 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12422 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12423 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12424 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12425 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12426 used for listening. Consider this example:
12428 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12430 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12432 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12434 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12435 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12438 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12439 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12440 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12441 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12442 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12443 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12444 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12445 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12449 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12450 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12451 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12452 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12453 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12454 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12463 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12464 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12465 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12466 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12469 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12470 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12472 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12473 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12474 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12476 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12477 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12478 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12479 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12483 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12484 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12485 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12486 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12487 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12488 listed in more than one group.
12490 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12492 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12493 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12494 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12495 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12496 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12497 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12498 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12499 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12500 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12504 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12506 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12507 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12508 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12509 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12510 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12511 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12516 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12518 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12519 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12520 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12521 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12522 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12523 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12524 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12525 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12526 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12527 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12528 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12533 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12535 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12536 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12537 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12538 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12539 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12540 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12541 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12542 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12543 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12544 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12545 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12546 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12551 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12553 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12554 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12555 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12556 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12561 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12563 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12564 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12565 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12566 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12567 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12568 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12569 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12570 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12571 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12572 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12573 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12574 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12575 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12576 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12577 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12582 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12584 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12585 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12590 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12592 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12593 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12598 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12600 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12601 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12602 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12603 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12604 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12605 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12606 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12611 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12613 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12614 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12615 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12616 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12617 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12618 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12619 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12620 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12621 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12622 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12623 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12624 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12625 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12626 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12627 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12628 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12630 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12631 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12632 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12633 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12634 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12639 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12641 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12642 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12643 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12644 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12645 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12646 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12647 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12648 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12649 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12650 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12651 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12652 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12653 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12654 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12655 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12656 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12657 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12658 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12659 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12660 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12662 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12663 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12664 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12665 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12666 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12667 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12668 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12669 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12670 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12671 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12672 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12673 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12674 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12675 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12676 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12677 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12678 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12679 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12684 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12686 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12688 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12690 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12691 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12692 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12697 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12699 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12700 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12701 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12702 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12703 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12704 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12705 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12706 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12707 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12708 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12709 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12710 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12711 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12712 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12717 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12719 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12720 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12721 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12722 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12723 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12724 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12725 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12726 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12731 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12733 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12734 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12735 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12736 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12737 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12738 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12739 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12740 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12746 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12748 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12755 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12756 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12759 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12760 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12761 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12762 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12763 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12764 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12765 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12766 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12767 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12768 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12769 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12770 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12771 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12772 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12774 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12775 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12776 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12777 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12778 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12779 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12780 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12781 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12782 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12783 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12784 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12785 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12786 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12787 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12788 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12789 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12794 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12796 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12797 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12798 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12799 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12800 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12801 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12806 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12808 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12809 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12810 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12811 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12813 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12814 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12815 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12816 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12817 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12818 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12819 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12820 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12821 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12822 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12827 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12829 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12830 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12832 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12833 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12834 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12835 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12836 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12841 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12843 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12844 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12845 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12846 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12847 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12848 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12849 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12850 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12851 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12852 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12853 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12854 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12855 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12856 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12857 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12858 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12859 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12860 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12861 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12862 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12863 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12864 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12869 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12871 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12872 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12873 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12874 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12875 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12876 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12877 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12878 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12879 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12880 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12881 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12882 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12883 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12884 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12889 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12890 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12894 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
12896 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12897 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12898 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12899 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12900 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12902 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
12903 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
12904 It now defaults to true.
12905 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
12907 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
12911 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12912 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12913 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12914 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12915 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12918 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12919 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12920 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12923 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12924 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12925 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12926 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12927 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12929 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12930 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12931 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12932 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12933 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12935 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12936 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12937 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12938 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12940 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12941 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12942 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12943 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12944 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12946 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12947 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12948 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12949 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12951 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12952 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12953 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12954 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12956 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12957 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12958 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12959 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12960 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12963 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12964 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12965 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12966 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12968 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12969 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12970 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12971 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12972 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12974 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12975 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12976 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12977 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12978 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12980 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12981 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12982 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12985 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12986 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12987 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12988 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12990 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12991 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12992 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12993 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12995 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12996 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12997 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12998 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13000 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13001 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13002 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13003 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13006 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
13007 .cindex "environment" "inherited"
13008 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
13009 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
13010 default list is empty,
13013 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13014 .cindex "admin user"
13015 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13016 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13017 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13018 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13019 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13020 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13021 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13023 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13024 .cindex "domain literal"
13025 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13026 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13027 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13028 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13030 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13031 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13032 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13033 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13034 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13035 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13036 the local host's IP addresses.
13039 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13040 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13041 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13042 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13043 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13044 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13045 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13046 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13047 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13049 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13050 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13051 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13052 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13053 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13054 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13055 experiment if they wish.
13057 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13058 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13059 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13060 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13061 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13062 suitable setting is:
13064 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13065 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13067 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13069 dns_check_names_pattern =
13071 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13074 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13075 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13076 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13077 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13078 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13079 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13080 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13081 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13082 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13083 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13084 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13086 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13087 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13088 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13089 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13090 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13091 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13093 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13094 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13095 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13096 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13098 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13100 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13101 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13102 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13103 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13106 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13107 .cindex "thawing messages"
13108 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13109 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13110 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13111 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13112 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13113 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13115 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13116 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13117 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13120 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13121 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13122 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13124 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13126 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13127 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13130 .option bi_command main string unset
13132 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13133 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13134 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13135 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13138 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13139 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13140 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13141 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13142 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13143 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13146 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13147 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13148 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13149 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13151 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13152 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13153 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13154 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13155 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13156 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13157 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13158 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13159 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13160 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13162 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13163 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13164 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13165 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13168 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13169 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13170 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13171 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13172 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13173 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13174 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13175 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13176 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13178 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13179 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13180 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13181 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13182 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13185 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13186 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13187 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13188 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13189 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13190 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13191 connection. A typical setting might be:
13193 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13195 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13197 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13199 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13202 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13203 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13204 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13205 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13206 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13207 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13210 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13211 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13212 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13213 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13216 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13217 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13218 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13219 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13222 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13223 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13224 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13225 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13228 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13229 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13230 callout verification. The default value is
13232 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13234 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13237 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13238 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13241 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13242 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13244 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13245 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13246 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13247 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13248 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13249 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13250 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13251 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13252 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13253 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13256 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13257 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13260 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13261 .cindex "checking disk space"
13262 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13263 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13264 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13265 message is accepted.
13267 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13268 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13269 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13270 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13271 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13272 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13273 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13274 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13277 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13278 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13280 check_spool_space = 10M
13281 check_spool_inodes = 100
13283 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13284 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13287 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13288 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13289 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13291 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13292 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13293 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13294 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13295 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13296 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13298 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13299 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13301 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13302 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13303 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13305 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13306 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13307 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13308 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13309 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13310 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13312 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13313 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13314 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13315 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13316 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13317 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13318 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13320 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13321 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13323 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13324 .cindex "warning of delay"
13325 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13326 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13327 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13328 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13329 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13330 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13331 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13334 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13336 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13337 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13338 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13339 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13343 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13344 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13346 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13349 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13350 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13351 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13352 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13353 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13354 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13355 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13356 not sent. The default is:
13358 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13359 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13360 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13361 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13364 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13365 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13366 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13367 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13369 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13370 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13371 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13372 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13373 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13374 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13375 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13376 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13378 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13379 .cindex "load average"
13380 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13381 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13382 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13383 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13384 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13387 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13388 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13389 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13390 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13391 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13392 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13393 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13394 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13396 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13397 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13398 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13399 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13400 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13401 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13402 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13403 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13405 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13406 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13407 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13408 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13411 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13412 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13413 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13414 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13415 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13416 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13417 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13420 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13421 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13422 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13423 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13424 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13425 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13426 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13427 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13428 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13429 by a setting such as this:
13431 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13433 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13434 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13435 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13436 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13437 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13438 options are applied after this global option.
13440 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13441 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13442 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13443 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13444 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13445 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13446 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13447 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13448 value of this option. The default pattern is
13450 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13451 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13453 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13454 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13455 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13456 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13457 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13460 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13461 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13462 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13464 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13465 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13466 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13467 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13469 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13470 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13471 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13472 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13473 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13474 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13475 domain matches this list.
13477 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13478 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13479 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13482 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13483 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13484 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13485 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13486 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13487 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13488 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13489 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13490 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13491 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13495 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13496 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13500 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13501 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13502 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13503 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13504 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13505 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13508 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13512 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13513 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13514 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13515 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13517 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13518 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13519 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13520 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13521 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13522 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13524 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13526 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13527 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13529 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13530 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13531 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13532 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13533 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13534 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13535 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13536 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13537 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13540 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13541 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13542 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13543 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13544 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13545 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13546 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13547 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13548 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13550 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13551 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13552 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13553 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13554 are examined. For example:
13556 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13557 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13558 postmaster@mydomain.example
13560 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13561 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13562 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13563 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13564 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13565 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13566 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13569 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13570 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13571 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13573 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13575 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13576 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13577 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13578 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13579 overrides the default.
13581 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13582 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13583 and warning messages. For example:
13585 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13587 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13588 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13589 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13590 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13594 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13595 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13596 .cindex "Exim group"
13597 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13598 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13599 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13600 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13601 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13605 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13606 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13607 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13608 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13609 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13610 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13612 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13613 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13614 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13615 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13618 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13619 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13620 .cindex "Exim user"
13621 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13622 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13623 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13624 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13626 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13627 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13628 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13629 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13632 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13633 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13634 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13635 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13638 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13639 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13641 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13642 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13644 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13645 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13646 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13647 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13648 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13649 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13650 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13651 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13652 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13653 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13657 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13658 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13659 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13660 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13661 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13662 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13663 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13664 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13667 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13668 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13669 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13670 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13674 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13675 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13676 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13677 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13678 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13679 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13680 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13681 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13682 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13683 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13684 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13685 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13686 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13687 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13688 logging that you require.
13691 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13693 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13694 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13695 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13696 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13697 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13698 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13699 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13700 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13702 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13703 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13704 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13707 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13708 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13709 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13710 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13712 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13716 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13717 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13720 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13721 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13722 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13723 implementations of TLS.
13725 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13726 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13727 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13728 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13729 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13730 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13734 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13735 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13736 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13737 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13738 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13739 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13740 sections are rejected.
13743 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13744 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13745 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13746 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13747 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13748 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13749 zero means &"no limit"&.
13754 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13755 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13756 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13757 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13758 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13759 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13760 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13761 if you want to do semantic checking.
13762 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13766 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13767 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13768 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13769 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13770 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13771 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13772 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13774 helo_allow_chars = _
13776 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13779 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13780 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13781 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13782 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13783 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13784 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13785 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13789 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13790 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13791 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13792 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13793 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13794 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13795 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13796 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13797 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13798 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13799 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13800 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13802 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13803 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13804 EHLO command either:
13807 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13809 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13810 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13811 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13812 calling host address, or
13814 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13815 available) yields the calling host address.
13818 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13819 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13820 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13822 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13823 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13824 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13825 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13826 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13827 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13828 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13829 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13830 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13833 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13834 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13835 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13836 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13837 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13838 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13839 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13840 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13841 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13843 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13844 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13845 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13846 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13847 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13849 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13850 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13851 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13852 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13855 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13856 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13857 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13858 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13859 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13860 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13861 default configuration file contains
13865 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13866 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13868 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13869 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13870 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13872 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13873 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13874 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13875 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13876 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13877 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13880 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13881 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13882 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13883 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13884 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13887 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13888 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13889 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13890 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13894 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13895 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13896 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13897 as soon as the connection is made.
13898 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13899 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13900 connections immediately.
13902 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13903 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13904 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13905 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13906 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13909 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13910 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13911 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13912 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13913 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13914 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13915 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13916 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13917 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13919 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13921 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13925 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13926 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13927 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13928 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13929 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13931 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13932 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13934 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13935 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13936 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13937 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13938 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13939 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13940 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13943 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13944 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13945 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13946 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13947 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13951 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13952 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13953 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13954 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13955 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13956 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13958 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13959 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13960 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13961 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13962 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13963 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13964 for frozen messages. For example,
13966 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13968 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13969 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13970 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13971 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13972 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13973 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13976 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13977 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13978 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13979 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13980 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13981 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13982 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13983 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13984 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13985 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13988 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13989 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13992 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
13993 .cindex "environment" "inherited"
13994 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
13995 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
13996 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
13997 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
13998 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
13999 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
14000 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
14002 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
14003 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
14005 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
14006 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
14007 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
14008 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
14010 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startupif you do not mention
14011 &%keep_environment%& or &%add_environment%& in your runtime configuration
14016 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14017 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14018 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14019 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14023 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14024 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14025 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14026 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14027 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14028 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14029 and constrained to be a directory.
14032 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14033 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14034 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14035 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14036 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14037 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14038 and constrained to be a file.
14041 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14042 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14043 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14044 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14045 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14048 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14049 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14050 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14051 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14052 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14053 identity to be proven.
14056 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14057 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14058 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14059 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14060 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14063 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14064 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14065 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14066 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14067 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14071 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14072 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14073 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14074 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14075 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14076 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14080 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14081 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14082 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14083 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14084 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14086 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14087 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14090 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14091 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14092 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14093 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14094 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14095 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14096 has been built with LDAP support.
14100 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14101 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14102 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14103 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14104 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14105 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14106 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14108 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14109 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14110 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14112 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14113 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14114 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14115 and the default qualify domain.
14117 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14118 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14119 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14120 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14122 .cindex "envelope sender"
14123 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14124 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14125 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14127 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14128 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14129 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14134 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14135 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14136 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14137 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14138 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14139 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14140 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14143 local_from_prefix = *-
14145 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14147 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14149 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14150 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14154 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14155 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14158 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14159 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14160 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14161 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14162 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14163 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14164 &%local_interfaces%& is
14166 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14168 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14170 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14173 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14174 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14175 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14176 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14177 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14178 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14179 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14180 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14184 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14185 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14186 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14187 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14188 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14189 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14190 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14191 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14196 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14197 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14198 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14199 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14200 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14201 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14202 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14203 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14204 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14205 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14206 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14207 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14208 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14209 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14210 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14214 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14215 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14216 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14217 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14218 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14219 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14220 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14221 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14222 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14223 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14224 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14225 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14226 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14227 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14230 .option log_selector main string unset
14231 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14232 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14233 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14234 minus characters. For example:
14236 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14238 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14239 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14242 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14243 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14244 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14245 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14246 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14247 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14248 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14249 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14250 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14251 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14252 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14253 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14254 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14257 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14258 .cindex "too many open files"
14259 .cindex "open files, too many"
14260 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14261 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14262 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14263 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14264 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14265 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14266 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14267 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14268 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14269 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14270 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14271 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14274 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14275 .cindex "length of login name"
14276 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14277 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14278 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14279 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14280 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14281 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14284 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14285 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14286 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14287 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14288 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14289 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14290 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14291 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14294 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14295 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14296 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14297 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14298 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14299 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14300 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14303 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14304 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14305 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14306 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14307 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14308 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14309 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14310 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14311 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14312 empty string, the option is ignored.
14315 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14316 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14317 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14318 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14319 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14320 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14321 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14322 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14323 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14324 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14325 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14326 colons will become hyphens.
14329 .option message_logs main boolean true
14330 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14331 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14332 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14333 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14334 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14335 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14336 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14337 which is not affected by this option.
14340 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14341 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14342 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14343 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14344 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14345 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14346 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14347 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14348 optionally followed by K or M.
14350 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14351 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14352 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14353 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14354 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14356 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14357 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14358 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14359 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14360 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14361 message that an individual transport can process.
14363 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14364 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14365 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14366 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14367 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14368 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14369 some problems may result.
14371 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14372 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14373 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14376 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14377 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14378 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14380 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14382 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14383 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14384 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14385 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14386 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14389 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14390 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14391 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14392 contains a full description of this facility.
14396 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14397 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14398 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14399 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14400 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14403 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14404 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14405 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14406 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14407 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14410 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14411 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14412 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14413 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14414 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14416 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14417 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14420 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14422 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14423 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14427 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14428 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14429 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14430 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14431 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14433 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14434 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14435 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14436 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14437 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14438 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14439 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14441 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14442 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14443 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14444 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14445 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14448 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14449 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14450 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14451 some now infamous attacks.
14456 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14457 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14458 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14461 Possible options may include:
14465 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14467 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14469 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14473 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14475 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14477 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14479 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14481 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14483 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14487 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14503 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14505 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14507 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14509 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14513 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14517 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14518 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14519 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14520 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14521 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14524 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14525 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14526 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14527 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14528 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14529 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14530 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14531 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14532 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14533 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14536 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14537 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14538 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14539 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14540 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14541 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14542 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14545 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14546 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14547 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14550 .option perl_startup main string unset
14551 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14552 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14555 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14556 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14557 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14558 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14559 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14560 PostgreSQL support.
14563 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14564 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14565 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14566 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14567 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14570 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14572 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14574 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14575 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14576 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14579 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14580 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14581 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14582 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14583 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14584 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14585 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14586 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14587 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14590 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14591 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14592 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14593 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14594 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14595 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14596 volume of mail. Use with care!
14599 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14600 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14601 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14602 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14603 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14604 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14605 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14606 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14607 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14608 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14610 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14611 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14612 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14613 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14614 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14615 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14618 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14619 .cindex "printing characters"
14620 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14621 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14622 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14623 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14624 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14625 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14628 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14629 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14630 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14631 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14632 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14636 .option process_log_path main string unset
14637 .cindex "process log path"
14638 .cindex "log" "process log"
14639 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14640 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14641 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14642 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14643 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14644 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14645 different spool directories.
14648 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14652 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14653 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14654 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14657 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14658 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14659 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14660 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14661 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14662 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14663 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14664 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14665 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14667 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14668 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14669 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14670 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14671 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14672 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14673 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14676 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14677 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14678 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14682 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14683 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14684 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14685 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14686 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14687 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14688 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14689 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14692 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14694 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14695 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14696 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14699 .option queue_only main boolean false
14700 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14701 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14702 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14703 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14704 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14705 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14707 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14708 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14709 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14710 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14713 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14714 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14715 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14716 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14717 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14718 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14719 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14720 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14721 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14723 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14725 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14726 &_/some/file_& exists.
14729 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14730 .cindex "load average"
14731 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14732 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14733 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14734 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14735 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14736 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14737 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14740 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14741 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14742 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14743 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14746 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14747 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14748 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14749 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14750 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14751 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14752 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14753 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14754 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14755 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14756 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14757 re-evaluated for each message.
14760 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14761 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14762 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14763 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14764 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14765 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14768 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14769 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14770 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14771 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14772 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14773 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14774 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14775 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14776 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14777 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14778 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14779 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14780 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14784 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14785 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14786 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14787 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14788 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14789 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14790 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14791 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14792 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14794 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14795 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14796 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14797 the daemon's command line.
14799 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14800 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14801 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14802 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14803 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14804 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14805 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14806 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14807 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14808 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14809 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14810 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14811 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14815 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14816 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14817 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14818 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14819 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14820 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14821 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14823 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14824 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14825 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14826 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14827 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14828 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14829 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14830 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14831 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14832 header lines. The default setting is:
14835 received_header_text = Received: \
14836 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14837 {${if def:sender_ident \
14838 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14839 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14840 by $primary_hostname \
14841 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14842 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14843 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14844 ${if def:sender_address \
14845 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14846 id $message_exim_id\
14847 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14850 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14851 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14852 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14853 header lines such as the following:
14855 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14856 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14857 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14858 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14859 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14860 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14861 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14863 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14864 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14865 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14866 message was accepted.
14869 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14870 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14871 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14872 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14873 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14874 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14875 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14876 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14879 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14880 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14881 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14882 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14883 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14884 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14885 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14886 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14887 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14888 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14889 option was not set.
14892 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14893 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14894 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14895 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14896 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14897 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14898 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14899 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14902 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14903 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14904 RCPT commands in a single message.
14907 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14908 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14909 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14910 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14911 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14912 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14913 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14916 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14917 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14918 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14919 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14920 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14921 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14922 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14923 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14924 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14925 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14926 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14927 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14928 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14929 tagged with its process id.
14931 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14932 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14933 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14934 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14937 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14938 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14939 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14940 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14941 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14942 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14943 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14944 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14945 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14946 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14947 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14949 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14950 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14951 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14952 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14955 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14956 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14957 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14958 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14959 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14961 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14963 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14964 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14967 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14968 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14969 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14970 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14971 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14975 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14976 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14977 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14978 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14979 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14980 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14981 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14985 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14986 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14987 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14988 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14989 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14990 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14991 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14992 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14993 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14994 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14997 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14998 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15001 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15003 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15004 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15007 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15008 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15009 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15010 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15011 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15014 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15015 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15016 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15017 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15018 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15019 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15020 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15021 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15022 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15023 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15025 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
15026 .cindex "environment"
15027 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
15028 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
15029 default list is empty,
15032 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15033 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15034 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15035 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15036 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15037 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15038 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15039 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15040 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15041 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15042 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15046 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15047 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15048 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15050 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15051 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15052 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15053 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15054 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15055 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15057 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15058 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15059 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15060 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15063 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15064 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15065 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15066 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15067 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15068 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15069 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15070 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15072 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15073 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15074 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15075 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15076 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15077 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15078 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15079 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15082 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15083 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15084 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15085 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15089 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15090 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15092 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15093 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15094 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15095 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15096 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15097 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15098 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15099 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15100 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15104 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15105 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15106 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15107 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15108 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15109 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15110 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15111 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15112 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15113 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15114 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15116 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15117 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15118 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15119 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15120 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15121 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15125 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15126 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15127 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15128 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15129 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15130 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15131 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15132 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15133 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15134 to all messages received in the same connection.
15136 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15137 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15138 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15139 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15142 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15143 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15145 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15146 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15147 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15148 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15149 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15150 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15151 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15152 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15153 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15154 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15155 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15156 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15157 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15160 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15161 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15162 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15163 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15164 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15165 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15166 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15167 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15168 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15169 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15170 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15173 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15174 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15175 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15176 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15179 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15180 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15181 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15182 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15183 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15184 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15185 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15186 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15187 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15189 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15190 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15191 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15192 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15194 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15195 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15196 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15197 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15198 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15201 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15202 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15205 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15206 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15207 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15208 &%helo_data%& value.
15210 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15211 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15212 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15213 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15214 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15215 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15216 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15218 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15219 $version_number $tod_full
15221 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15222 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15223 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15224 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15225 multiline response).
15228 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15229 .cindex "checking disk space"
15230 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15231 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15232 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15233 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15234 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15235 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15236 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15239 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15240 .cindex "connection backlog"
15241 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15242 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15243 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15244 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15245 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15246 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15247 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15248 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15249 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15250 attacks by SYN flooding.
15253 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15254 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15255 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15256 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15257 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15258 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15259 fewer, but they still exist.
15261 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15262 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15263 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15264 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15265 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15266 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15267 does detect many instances.
15269 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15270 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15271 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15272 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15276 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15277 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15278 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15279 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15280 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15281 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15282 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15283 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15286 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15287 $sender_host_address
15289 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15290 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15291 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15292 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15293 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15297 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15298 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15299 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15300 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15301 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15304 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15305 .cindex "load average"
15306 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15307 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15308 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15309 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15310 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15311 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15315 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15316 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15317 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15318 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15319 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15321 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15323 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15324 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15325 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15326 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15327 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15329 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15330 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15331 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15332 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15333 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15334 not count towards the limit.
15338 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15339 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15340 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15341 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15342 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15345 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15346 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15350 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15351 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15352 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15353 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15354 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15355 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15358 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15359 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15360 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15361 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15363 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15364 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15365 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15366 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15370 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15372 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15373 fractional parts are allowed here.
15375 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15377 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15378 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15381 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15382 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15384 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15385 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15387 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15388 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15389 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15390 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15393 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15394 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15397 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15398 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15401 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15402 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15403 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15404 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15405 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15406 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15407 the message is abandoned.
15408 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15410 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15411 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15413 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15414 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15418 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15419 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15420 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15421 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15422 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15425 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15426 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15427 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15430 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15431 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15432 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15433 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15434 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15435 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15436 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15437 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15438 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15439 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15441 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15442 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15445 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15446 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15447 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15448 The default value is
15452 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15456 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15457 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15458 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15459 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15460 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15461 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15462 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15463 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15464 arrival of the message.
15466 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15467 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15468 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15469 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15470 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15472 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15473 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15474 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15475 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15476 automatically deleted.
15478 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15479 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15480 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15481 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15482 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15483 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15484 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15485 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15486 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15489 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15490 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15491 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15492 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15493 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15494 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15495 &$primary_hostname$&.
15497 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15498 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15499 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15500 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15501 as failures in the configuration file.
15503 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15504 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15506 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15507 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15508 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15509 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15511 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15512 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15513 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15514 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15515 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15516 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15518 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15519 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15520 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15521 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15522 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15523 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15524 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15527 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15528 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15529 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15530 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15531 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15532 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15533 domain causes a syntax error.
15534 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15538 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15539 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15540 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15541 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15542 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15543 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15544 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15545 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15546 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15547 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15548 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15549 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15552 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15553 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15554 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15555 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15556 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15557 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15558 details of Exim's logging.
15562 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15563 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15564 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15565 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15566 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15570 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15571 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15572 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15573 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15574 details of Exim's logging.
15577 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15578 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15579 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15580 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15581 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15582 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15583 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15584 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15585 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15586 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15587 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15590 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15591 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15592 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15593 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15594 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15595 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15598 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15599 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15600 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15601 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15602 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15604 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15605 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15606 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15607 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15608 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15610 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15611 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15612 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15613 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15614 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15615 contains the pipe command.
15618 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15619 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15620 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15621 is used in a system filter.
15624 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15625 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15626 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15627 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15628 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15629 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15630 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15631 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15632 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15633 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15635 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15636 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15637 transport option overrides.
15640 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15641 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15642 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15643 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15644 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15645 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15646 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15647 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15648 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15649 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15650 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15651 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15655 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15656 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15657 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15658 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15659 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15660 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15661 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15662 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15663 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15664 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15666 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15667 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15668 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15671 .option timezone main string unset
15672 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15673 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15674 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15675 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15676 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15680 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15681 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15682 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15683 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15684 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15685 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15688 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15689 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15690 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15691 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15692 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15693 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15694 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15695 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15698 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15699 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15700 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15701 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15702 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15703 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15704 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15706 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15707 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15708 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15709 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15712 If the option contains &$tls_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15713 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15714 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15715 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15718 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15719 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15720 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15721 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15722 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15725 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15730 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15731 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15732 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15733 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15734 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15735 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15737 The value must be at least 1024.
15739 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15740 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15741 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15743 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15746 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
15747 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
15748 larger prime than requested.
15752 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15753 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15755 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
15756 to be used by Exim.
15758 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
15759 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
15760 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
15761 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
15762 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
15763 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
15764 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
15766 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
15769 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
15770 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
15771 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
15772 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
15774 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
15775 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
15776 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
15777 in IKE is assigned number 23.
15779 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
15780 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
15781 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
15784 The available primes are:
15785 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
15786 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
15787 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
15789 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
15790 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
15794 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15795 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15796 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15797 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15798 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15802 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15803 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15804 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15805 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15806 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15807 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15808 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15811 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15815 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15816 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15817 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15818 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15819 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15820 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15824 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15825 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15826 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15827 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15828 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15829 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15830 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15831 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15832 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15833 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15834 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15837 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15838 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15839 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15840 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15843 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15844 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15845 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15846 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15847 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15848 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15849 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15850 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15851 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15853 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15854 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15855 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15856 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15857 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15858 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15861 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15865 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15866 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15867 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15868 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15869 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15870 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15871 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15872 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15874 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15875 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15876 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15877 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15878 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15879 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15880 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15882 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15883 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15884 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15885 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15886 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15887 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15888 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15891 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15895 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15896 .cindex "trusted groups"
15897 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15898 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15899 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15900 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15901 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15902 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15903 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15906 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15907 .cindex "trusted users"
15908 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15909 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15910 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15911 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15912 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15913 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15914 Exim user are trusted.
15916 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15917 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15918 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15919 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15920 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15921 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15922 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15923 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15924 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15927 .option unknown_username main string unset
15928 See &%unknown_login%&.
15930 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15931 .cindex "trusted users"
15932 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15933 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15934 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15935 .cindex "envelope sender"
15936 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15937 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15938 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15939 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15940 is used) is ignored.
15942 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15943 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15945 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15947 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15948 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15949 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15950 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15951 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15952 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15953 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15954 followed by a hyphen
15955 by a setting like this:
15957 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15959 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15960 restriction, you can use
15962 untrusted_set_sender = *
15964 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15965 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15966 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15967 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15968 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15969 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15970 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15971 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15973 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15974 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15975 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15976 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15980 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15981 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15982 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15983 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15984 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15985 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15986 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15987 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15988 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15989 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15991 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15992 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15994 The pattern can be seen by running
15996 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15998 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15999 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16000 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16001 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16002 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16003 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16006 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16007 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16010 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16011 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16012 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16013 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16014 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16015 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16016 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16017 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16020 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16021 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16022 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16023 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16024 .ecindex IIDconfima
16025 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16033 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16034 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16035 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16036 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16037 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16039 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16040 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16041 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16042 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16043 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16047 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16048 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16049 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16050 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16051 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16052 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16053 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16055 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16056 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16057 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16058 routers, and the eventual transport.
16060 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16061 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16062 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16063 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16064 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16066 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16067 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16068 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16069 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16070 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16072 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16073 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16074 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16076 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16078 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16080 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16082 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16083 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16085 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16086 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16087 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16088 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16089 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16090 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16091 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16095 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16097 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16098 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16099 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16100 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16101 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16106 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16107 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16108 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16109 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16110 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16111 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16112 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16113 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16114 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16115 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16118 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16120 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16123 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16125 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16126 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16127 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16128 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16131 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16132 .cindex "case of local parts"
16133 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16134 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16135 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16136 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16137 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16138 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16139 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16142 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16143 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16144 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16145 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16146 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16147 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16148 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16149 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16150 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16152 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16153 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16154 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16155 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16159 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16160 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16161 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16162 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16164 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16165 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16166 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16167 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16168 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16169 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16170 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16171 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16172 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16173 the router is skipped.
16175 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16176 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16177 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16178 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16179 setting to achieve this. For example:
16181 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16183 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16184 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16185 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16189 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16190 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16191 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16192 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16193 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16194 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16195 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16196 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16198 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16199 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16201 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16202 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16204 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16205 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16206 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16208 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16210 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16212 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16215 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16217 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16218 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16222 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16223 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16224 be specified using &%condition%&.
16227 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16228 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16229 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16230 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16231 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16232 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16233 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16234 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16235 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16236 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16237 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16238 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16242 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16243 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16244 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16245 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16246 transport option of the same name.
16249 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16250 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16251 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16252 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16253 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16254 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16255 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16256 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16260 .option driver routers string unset
16261 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16266 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16267 .cindex "envelope sender"
16268 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16269 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16270 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16271 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16272 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16273 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16274 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16276 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16277 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16278 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16281 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16282 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16283 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16284 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16286 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16287 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16288 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16289 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16295 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16296 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16297 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16298 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16299 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16301 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16302 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16303 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16304 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16305 setting &%return_path%&.
16307 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16308 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16309 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16313 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16314 .cindex "address" "testing"
16315 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16316 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16317 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16318 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16319 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16320 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16321 on for the system alias file.
16322 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16325 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16326 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16327 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16331 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16332 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16333 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16334 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16338 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16339 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16340 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16344 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16345 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16346 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16350 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16351 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16352 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16353 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16354 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16355 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16356 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16357 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16358 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16360 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16361 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16362 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16363 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16364 transport for further details.
16367 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16368 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16369 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16370 .cindex "transport" "local"
16371 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16372 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16373 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16375 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16376 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16377 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16378 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16379 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16383 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16384 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16385 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16386 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16387 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16388 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16389 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16390 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16391 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16392 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16393 &"see"& the added header lines.
16395 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16396 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16397 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16398 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16400 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16401 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16403 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16404 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16405 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16406 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16407 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16408 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16409 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16410 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16411 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16412 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16416 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16417 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16418 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16419 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16420 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16421 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16422 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16423 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16424 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16425 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16426 &"see"& the original header lines.
16428 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16429 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16430 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16433 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16434 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16436 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16437 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16438 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16439 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16442 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16443 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16444 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16445 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16446 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16447 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16448 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16451 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16455 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16457 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16458 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16459 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16460 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16461 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16462 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16464 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16465 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16467 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16468 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16470 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16471 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16473 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16474 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16475 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16476 domain that is being routed.
16478 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16479 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16482 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16483 .cindex "additional groups"
16484 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16485 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16486 .cindex "transport" "local"
16487 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16488 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16489 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16490 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16491 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16495 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16496 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16497 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16498 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16499 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16500 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16503 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16504 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16505 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16506 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16507 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16508 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16509 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16510 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16511 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16513 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16514 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16515 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16516 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16517 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16518 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16519 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16520 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16521 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16522 the relevant transport.
16524 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16525 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16526 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16529 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16530 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16531 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16532 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16533 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16537 local_part_prefix = real-
16539 transport = local_delivery
16541 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16542 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16544 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16545 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16548 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16549 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16550 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16551 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16554 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16555 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16559 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16560 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16561 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16562 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16563 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16564 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16565 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16566 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16567 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16571 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16572 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16576 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16577 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16578 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16579 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16580 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16582 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16583 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16586 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16588 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16589 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16590 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16591 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16592 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16593 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16594 each virtual domain:
16598 local_parts = postmaster
16599 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16603 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16604 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16605 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16606 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16607 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16608 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16609 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16610 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16611 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16612 redirect addresses.
16616 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16617 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16618 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16619 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16620 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16621 delivery to be deferred.
16623 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16624 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16626 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16627 means of the setting
16631 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16632 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16633 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16635 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16636 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16637 controls what happens next.
16640 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16641 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16642 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16643 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16644 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16645 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16646 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16647 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16649 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16650 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16651 applies to all of them.
16655 .option pass_router routers string unset
16656 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16657 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16658 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16659 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16660 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16661 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16662 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16663 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16664 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16665 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16669 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16670 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16671 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16672 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16673 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16674 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16676 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16677 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16678 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16679 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16683 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16684 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16685 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16686 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16687 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16688 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16689 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16691 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16692 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16693 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16694 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16696 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16697 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16698 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16699 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16700 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16703 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16704 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16707 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16708 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16709 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16710 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16711 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16712 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16713 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16714 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16716 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16717 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16718 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16719 operates as follows:
16721 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16722 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16723 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16724 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16727 require_files = mail:/some/file
16728 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16730 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16731 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16733 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16734 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16735 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16736 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16738 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16739 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16740 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16741 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16742 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16744 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16745 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16746 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16747 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16748 check again in that process.
16750 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16751 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16752 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16753 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16754 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16755 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16756 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16758 require_files = +/some/file
16760 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16761 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16762 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16766 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16767 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16768 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16769 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16770 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16771 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16772 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16773 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16776 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16777 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16778 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16779 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16780 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16783 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16784 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16785 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16789 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16790 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16791 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16793 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16794 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16795 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16796 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16797 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16798 cause the router to defer.
16800 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16801 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16803 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16805 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16806 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16808 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16809 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16810 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16811 of these values that is set:
16814 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16816 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16818 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16820 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16823 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16824 router, but not for the transport.
16828 .option self routers string freeze
16829 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16830 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16831 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16832 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16833 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16834 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16836 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16837 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16838 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16839 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16840 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16842 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16843 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16844 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16845 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16846 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16851 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16853 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16854 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16855 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16856 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16858 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16859 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16860 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16865 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16866 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16867 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16868 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16869 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16870 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16876 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16877 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16878 be passed to the next router.
16881 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16884 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16885 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16886 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16887 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16888 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16889 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16894 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16895 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16896 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16897 address matches something on the list.
16898 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16901 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16902 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16903 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16904 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16905 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16906 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16907 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16911 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16912 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16913 .cindex "packet radio"
16914 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16915 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16916 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16917 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16918 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16919 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16920 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16921 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16923 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16924 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16925 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16926 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16927 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16928 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16929 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16930 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16931 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16932 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16934 translate_ip_address = \
16935 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16938 The file would contain lines like
16940 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16941 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16943 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16948 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16949 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16950 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16951 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16952 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16953 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16954 delivery is deferred.
16956 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16957 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16958 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16962 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16963 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16964 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16965 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16966 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16967 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16968 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16969 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16970 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16971 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16972 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16978 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16979 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16980 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16981 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16982 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16983 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16984 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16985 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16986 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16987 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16989 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16990 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16991 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16992 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16993 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16995 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17001 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17002 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17003 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17004 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17005 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17006 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17007 delivery to be deferred.
17009 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17010 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17011 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17012 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17013 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17014 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17016 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17017 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17018 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17019 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17020 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17021 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17022 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17023 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17025 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17026 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17027 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17028 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17029 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17030 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17031 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17032 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17033 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17034 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17036 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17037 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17038 subsequent routers.
17041 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17042 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17043 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17044 .cindex "transport" "local"
17045 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17046 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17047 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17048 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17049 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17050 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17051 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17052 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17053 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17054 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17055 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17056 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17060 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17061 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17062 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17065 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17066 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17068 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17069 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
17070 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17071 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17072 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17073 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17075 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17076 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17077 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17081 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17082 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17084 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17085 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17089 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17090 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17091 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17092 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17094 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17095 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17105 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17106 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17107 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17108 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17109 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17110 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17111 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17112 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17113 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17117 domains = mydomain.example
17119 transport = local_delivery
17121 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17122 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17123 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17124 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17134 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17135 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17136 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17137 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17138 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17139 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17141 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17142 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17143 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17144 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17147 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17148 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17149 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17150 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17151 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17152 generic option, the router declines.
17154 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17155 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17156 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17158 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17159 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17160 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17161 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17162 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17163 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17166 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17167 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17168 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17169 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17170 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17171 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17173 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17174 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17175 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17176 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17177 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17178 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17179 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17180 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17181 case routing fails.
17185 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17186 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17187 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17188 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17189 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17191 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17193 The domain does not exist in DNS
17195 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17196 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17197 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17199 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17201 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17203 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17204 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17206 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17207 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17209 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17210 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17212 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17213 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17220 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17221 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17222 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17224 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17225 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17226 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17227 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17228 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17229 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17230 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17233 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17234 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17235 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17236 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17237 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17238 required. For example,
17242 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17243 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17244 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17245 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17246 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17249 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17250 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17251 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17252 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17253 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17254 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17256 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17257 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17258 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17259 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17260 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17261 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17262 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17263 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17265 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17266 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17270 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17271 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17272 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17273 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17274 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17275 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17276 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17279 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17281 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17282 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17283 the address record.
17286 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17287 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17288 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17289 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17294 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17295 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17296 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17297 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17298 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17299 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17300 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17301 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17302 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17307 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17308 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17309 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17310 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17311 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17312 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17313 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17314 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17315 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17316 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17317 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17319 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17320 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17323 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17324 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17325 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17326 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17327 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17331 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17332 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17333 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17334 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17335 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17336 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17337 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17338 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17340 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17341 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17342 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17343 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17344 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17345 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17346 without processing them independently,
17347 provided the following conditions are met:
17350 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17351 &%headers_remove%&.
17353 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17360 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17361 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17362 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17363 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17364 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17365 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17366 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17367 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17368 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17369 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17371 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17372 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17377 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17378 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17379 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17380 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17385 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17386 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17387 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17388 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17391 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17393 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17394 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17395 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17396 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17397 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17398 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17401 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17402 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17403 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17404 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17405 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17407 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17408 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17409 such as that implied by
17413 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17414 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17415 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17416 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17426 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17427 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17429 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17430 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17431 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17432 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17433 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17434 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17435 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17436 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17437 router handles the address
17441 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17442 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17443 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17445 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17447 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17448 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17450 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17451 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17452 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17453 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17455 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17456 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17457 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17458 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17465 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17466 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17467 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17468 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17469 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17470 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17473 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17475 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17477 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17478 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17479 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17480 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17481 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17482 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17483 must not be specified for it.
17485 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17486 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17487 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17488 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17489 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17490 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17491 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17494 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17495 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17496 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17497 delivery to the address is deferred.
17500 .option port iplookup integer 0
17501 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17502 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17506 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17507 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17508 protocols is to be used.
17511 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17512 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17515 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17517 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17518 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17521 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17522 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17523 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17524 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17525 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17526 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17527 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17528 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17531 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17532 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17533 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17534 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17535 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17536 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17537 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17538 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17539 following could be used:
17541 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17542 reroute = $local_part@$1
17545 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17546 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17547 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17548 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17556 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17557 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17558 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17559 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17560 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17561 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17562 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17563 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17564 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17565 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17567 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17568 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17569 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17570 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17571 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17572 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17573 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17576 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17577 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17578 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17579 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17580 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17581 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17582 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17585 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17586 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17587 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17588 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17589 below, following the list of private options.
17592 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17594 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17595 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17597 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17598 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17600 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17601 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17602 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17603 of the following values:
17612 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17613 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17614 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17617 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17618 router only if &%more%& is true.
17620 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17621 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17622 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17623 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17625 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17626 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17627 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17630 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17631 .cindex "randomized host list"
17632 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17633 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17634 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17635 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17636 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17637 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17638 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17639 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17641 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17642 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17643 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17644 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17646 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17648 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17649 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17650 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17651 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17652 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17655 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17656 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17657 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17660 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17662 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17663 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17667 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17668 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17669 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17670 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17673 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17674 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17675 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17676 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17677 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17678 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17679 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17680 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17682 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17683 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17684 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17685 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17686 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17687 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17688 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17689 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17694 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17695 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17696 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17697 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17698 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17699 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17701 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17703 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17707 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17708 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17710 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17711 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17712 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17713 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17714 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17715 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17716 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17717 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17718 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17719 in a &%route_list%&).
17721 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17722 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17723 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17724 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17728 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17729 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17730 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17731 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17732 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17733 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17734 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17737 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17738 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17740 This data can be accessed by setting
17742 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17744 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17745 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17746 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17747 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17748 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17753 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17754 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17755 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17756 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17757 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17758 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17759 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17761 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17762 variables are set during its expansion:
17765 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17766 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17767 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17769 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17772 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17774 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17777 .vindex "&$value$&"
17778 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17779 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17781 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17785 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17786 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17790 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17791 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17792 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17793 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17794 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17795 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17798 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17799 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17800 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17802 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17803 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17806 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17807 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17808 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17809 number follows. For example:
17811 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17815 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17816 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17817 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17818 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17819 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17822 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17823 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17824 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17825 records in the DNS. For example:
17827 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17829 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17832 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17834 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17835 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17836 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17837 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17838 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17839 happens is controlled by the
17840 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17841 &%self%& option of the router.
17843 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17844 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17845 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17846 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17847 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17848 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17849 defined by MX preferences.
17851 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17852 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17853 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17855 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17856 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17857 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17858 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17860 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17861 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17864 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17865 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17866 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17868 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17869 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17873 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17874 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17875 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17876 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17877 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17878 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17879 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17882 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17883 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17885 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17886 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17888 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17889 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17890 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17892 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17893 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17894 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17899 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17900 domain2 host4:host5
17902 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17903 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17904 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17905 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17908 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17909 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17910 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17911 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17916 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17917 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17920 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17921 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17925 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17926 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17927 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17930 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17931 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17932 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17933 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17935 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17937 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17938 your first router something like this:
17941 driver = manualroute
17942 domains = !+local_domains
17943 transport = remote_smtp
17944 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17946 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17947 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17948 they are tried in order
17949 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17950 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17953 driver = manualroute
17954 transport = remote_smtp
17955 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17957 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17958 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17959 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17960 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17961 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17962 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17963 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17964 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17967 .cindex "mail hub example"
17968 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17969 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17970 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17971 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17972 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17973 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17974 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17975 lookup is easier to manage.
17977 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17978 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17982 driver = manualroute
17983 transport = remote_smtp
17984 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17986 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17987 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17988 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17989 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17990 domain can be used to find the host:
17993 driver = manualroute
17994 transport = remote_smtp
17995 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17997 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17998 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17999 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18003 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18004 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18005 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18006 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18007 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18008 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18011 driver = manualroute
18012 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18013 route_list = saved.domain.example
18015 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18016 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18017 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18020 driver = manualroute
18022 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18023 *.saved.domain2.example \
18024 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18027 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18029 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18030 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18031 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18032 the address if the lookup fails.
18035 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18036 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18037 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18038 one way it can be done:
18044 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18045 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18046 return_fail_output = true
18051 driver = manualroute
18053 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18055 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18057 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18059 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18060 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18061 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18063 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18064 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18076 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18077 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18078 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18079 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18080 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18081 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18082 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18083 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18084 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18085 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18087 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18089 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18090 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18091 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18092 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18093 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18096 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18097 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18098 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18099 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18100 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18101 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18104 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18105 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18106 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18107 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18108 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18109 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18110 not set, a value for the gid also.
18112 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18113 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18114 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18115 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18116 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18117 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18121 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18122 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18123 before running the command.
18126 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18127 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18128 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18132 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18133 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18134 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18135 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18136 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18139 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18142 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18143 &%no_more%& is set.
18145 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18146 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18147 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18148 included in the SMTP response.
18150 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18151 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18152 included in any SMTP response.
18154 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18156 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18157 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18159 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18160 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18161 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18164 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18165 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18168 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18169 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18171 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18172 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18173 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18174 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18176 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18177 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18178 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18179 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18180 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18182 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18183 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18184 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18185 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18186 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18188 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18189 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18190 variable. For example, this return line
18192 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18194 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18195 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18196 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18197 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18205 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18206 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18207 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18208 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18209 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18210 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18211 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18212 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18213 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18214 redirected in several different ways:
18217 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18220 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18222 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18224 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18226 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18228 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18230 It can be discarded.
18233 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18234 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18235 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18236 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18240 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18241 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18242 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18243 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18244 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18245 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18249 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18251 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18252 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18253 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18254 cause delivery to be deferred.
18256 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18257 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18262 file = $home/.forward
18265 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18266 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18267 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18268 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18273 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18274 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18275 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18276 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18279 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18280 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18281 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18282 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18284 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18285 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18286 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18287 saves some resources.
18295 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18296 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18297 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18298 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18299 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18302 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18303 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18304 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18305 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18306 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18307 document is intended for use by end users.
18309 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18310 described in the next section.
18313 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18314 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18315 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18316 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18317 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18321 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18322 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18323 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18324 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18325 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18326 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18327 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18328 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18329 commas or newlines.
18330 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18333 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18334 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18335 next newline character is ignored.
18337 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18338 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18339 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18340 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18343 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18344 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18345 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18346 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18347 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18348 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18351 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18355 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18356 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18357 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18358 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18359 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18360 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18361 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18362 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18363 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18364 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18365 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18367 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18368 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18369 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18370 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18371 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18373 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18375 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18376 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18377 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18378 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18379 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18382 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18383 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18384 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18385 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18386 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18388 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18389 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18394 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18395 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18398 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18400 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18401 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18402 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18403 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18404 should really contain
18406 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18408 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18409 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18410 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18414 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18415 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18416 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18419 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18420 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18421 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18422 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18423 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18424 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18425 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18427 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18428 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18429 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18430 in double quotes, for example:
18432 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18434 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18435 quote just the command. An item such as
18437 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18439 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18442 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18443 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18444 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18445 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18447 /home/world/minbari
18449 is treated as a file name, but
18451 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18453 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18454 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18455 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18456 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18458 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18459 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18461 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18462 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18463 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18464 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18467 .cindex "included address list"
18468 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18469 If an item is of the form
18471 :include:<path name>
18473 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18474 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18475 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18476 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18477 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18478 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18480 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18482 It must be given as
18484 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18487 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18488 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18489 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18490 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18491 .cindex "black hole"
18492 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18493 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18494 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18495 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18497 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18498 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18499 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18500 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18504 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18505 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18506 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18507 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18508 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18509 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18510 redirection items of the form
18515 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18516 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18517 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18518 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18520 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18522 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18524 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18525 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18527 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18528 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18529 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18531 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18532 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18533 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18534 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18535 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18536 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18537 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18538 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18539 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18542 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18543 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18544 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18545 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18547 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18548 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18549 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18550 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18551 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18553 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18554 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18555 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18556 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18557 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18561 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18562 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18563 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18564 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18565 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18566 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18567 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18571 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18572 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18573 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18574 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18575 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18576 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18577 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18578 aliasing scheme of the type
18580 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18584 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18585 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18586 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18589 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18590 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18592 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18593 the pipes are distinct.
18597 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18598 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18599 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18600 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18601 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18602 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18603 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18604 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18605 can be used to avoid this.
18608 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18609 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18610 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18611 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18612 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18613 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18614 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18618 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18620 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18621 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18624 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18625 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18626 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18629 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18630 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18631 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18632 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18635 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18636 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18637 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18638 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18639 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18640 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18641 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18643 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18644 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18647 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18648 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18649 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18650 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18651 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18655 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18656 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18657 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18658 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18659 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18660 let ordinary users do.
18664 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18665 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18666 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18667 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18668 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18669 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18671 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18672 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18673 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18674 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18675 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18676 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18678 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18680 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18681 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18682 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18683 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18684 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18685 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18686 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18687 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18690 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18691 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18692 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18693 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18694 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18695 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18696 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18697 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18701 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18702 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18703 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18704 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18705 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18706 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18709 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18710 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18711 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18712 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18713 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18714 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18716 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18717 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18718 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18720 data = #Exim filter\n\
18721 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18723 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18724 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18725 choice into a newline.
18728 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18729 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18730 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18731 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18732 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18735 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18736 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18737 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18738 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18739 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18740 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18741 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18742 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18744 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18745 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18746 runs a check on the containing directory,
18747 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18748 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18749 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18750 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18751 not, the router declines.
18754 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18755 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18756 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18757 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18758 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18759 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18760 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18763 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18764 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18765 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18766 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18767 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18770 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18771 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18775 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18776 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18777 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18782 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18783 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18784 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18785 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18786 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18787 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18788 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18789 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18790 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18793 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18794 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18795 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18796 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18799 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18800 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18801 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18802 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18804 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18805 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18806 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18807 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18808 &_.forward_& files).
18811 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18812 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18813 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18816 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18817 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18818 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18819 of the embedded Perl support.
18822 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18823 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18824 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18827 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18828 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18829 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18832 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18833 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18834 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18835 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18836 &%one_time%& is set.
18839 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18840 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18841 to make use of &%run%& items.
18844 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18845 If this option is true, items of the form
18847 :include:<path name>
18849 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18852 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18853 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18854 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18855 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18856 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18859 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18860 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18861 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18864 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18865 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18866 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18867 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18868 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18873 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18874 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18875 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18876 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18877 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18878 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18879 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18882 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18884 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18885 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18886 file did not exist.
18889 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18891 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18892 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18893 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18895 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18896 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18897 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18898 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18899 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18900 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18901 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18902 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18906 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18907 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18908 redirection list must start with this directory.
18911 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18912 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18913 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18916 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18917 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18918 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18919 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18920 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18921 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18922 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18923 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18924 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18925 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18926 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18927 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18928 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18929 before they subscribed.
18931 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18932 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18933 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18934 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18937 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18938 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18939 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18940 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18942 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18943 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18944 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18946 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18949 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18950 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18951 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18952 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18953 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18957 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18958 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18959 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18960 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18961 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18962 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18963 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18964 See &%check_owner%& above.
18967 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18968 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18969 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18970 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18973 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18974 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18975 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18976 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18977 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18978 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18979 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18982 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18983 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18984 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18985 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18986 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18987 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18988 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18989 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18991 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18992 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18993 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18996 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18997 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18998 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18999 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19000 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19001 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19002 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19003 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19004 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19005 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19008 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19009 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19010 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19011 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19012 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19013 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19016 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19017 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19018 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19019 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19020 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19021 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19024 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19025 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19026 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19027 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19028 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19031 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19032 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19033 :subaddress part of an address.
19035 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19036 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19037 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19038 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19041 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19042 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19043 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19044 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19045 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19046 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19047 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19051 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19052 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19053 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19054 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19055 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19056 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19057 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19058 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19059 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19060 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19061 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19062 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19063 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19064 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19065 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19066 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19068 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19069 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19070 the following routers.
19072 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19073 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19074 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19075 so it is passed to the following routers.
19077 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19078 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19079 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19080 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19082 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19083 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19084 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19085 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19091 file = $home/.forward
19092 file_transport = address_file
19093 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19094 reply_transport = address_reply
19097 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19098 syntax_errors_text = \
19099 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19100 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19101 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19102 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19103 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19104 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19105 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19106 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19107 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19108 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19110 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19111 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19112 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19117 local_part_prefix = real-
19118 transport = local_delivery
19120 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19121 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19123 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19124 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19128 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19129 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19132 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19133 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19134 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19135 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19145 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19146 "Environment for local transports"
19147 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19148 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19149 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19150 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19151 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19152 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19153 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19155 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19156 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19157 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19158 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19160 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19161 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19162 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19163 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19164 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19168 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19169 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19170 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19171 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19172 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19173 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19174 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19177 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19178 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19182 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19184 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19185 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19186 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19187 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19192 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19193 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19194 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19195 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19196 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19197 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19198 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19199 group (set by the transport). For example:
19202 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19206 transport = group_delivery
19209 # This transport overrides the group
19211 driver = appendfile
19212 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19215 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19216 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19217 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19220 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19221 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19222 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19223 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19224 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19225 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19227 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19228 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19229 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19230 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19231 original gid is also used.
19233 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19234 following that is set is used:
19237 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19239 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19241 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19242 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19244 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19246 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19247 the uid is the creator's uid;
19249 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19252 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19253 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19254 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19255 The first of the following that is set is used:
19258 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19260 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19262 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19264 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19269 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19270 &%never_users%& list.
19276 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19277 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19278 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19279 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19280 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19281 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19282 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19283 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19284 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19285 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19288 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19290 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19292 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19294 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19297 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19300 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19302 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19306 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19307 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19308 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19312 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19313 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19314 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19315 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19316 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19317 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19318 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19319 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19320 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19321 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19322 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19323 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19324 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19325 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19336 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19337 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19338 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19339 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19340 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19343 .option body_only transports boolean false
19344 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19345 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19346 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19347 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19348 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19349 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19350 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19351 automatically suppress them.
19354 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19355 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19356 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19357 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19358 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19359 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19362 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19363 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19364 deliveries by the transport or for any
19365 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19366 what you are doing.
19369 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19370 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19371 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19372 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19374 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19375 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19376 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19377 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19378 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19379 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19383 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19384 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19385 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19386 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19387 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19388 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19389 safely be resent to other recipients.
19392 .option driver transports string unset
19393 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19394 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19397 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19398 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19399 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19400 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19401 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19402 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19403 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19404 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19405 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19406 resent to other recipients.
19409 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19410 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19411 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19412 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19413 &%user%& (see below).
19416 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19417 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19418 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19419 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19420 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19421 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19422 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19423 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19424 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19428 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19429 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19430 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19431 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19432 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19433 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19434 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19435 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19438 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19439 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19440 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19441 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19442 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19443 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19444 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19445 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19446 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19450 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19451 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19452 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19453 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19454 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19455 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19456 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19457 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19460 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19463 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19464 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19465 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19466 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19467 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19468 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19469 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19470 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19471 change envelope recipients at this time.
19474 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19475 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19477 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19478 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19479 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19480 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19481 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19482 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19483 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19487 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19488 .cindex "additional groups"
19489 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19490 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19491 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19492 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19493 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19496 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19497 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19498 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19499 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19500 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19501 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19502 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19503 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19504 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19505 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19506 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19507 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19508 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19513 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19514 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19515 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19516 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19517 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19518 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19519 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19520 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19523 local_part_prefix = *-
19525 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19528 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19530 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19531 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19532 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19533 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19534 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19537 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19538 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19539 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19540 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19541 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19542 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19543 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19544 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19545 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19547 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19548 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19549 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19550 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19552 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19553 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19554 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19557 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19558 .cindex "envelope sender"
19559 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19560 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19561 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19562 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19563 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19564 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19565 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19566 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19567 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19569 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19570 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19572 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19573 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19574 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19575 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19576 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19577 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19578 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19580 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19581 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19582 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19583 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19584 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19588 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19589 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19590 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19591 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19592 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19593 have easy access to it.
19595 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19596 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19597 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19598 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19599 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19603 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19604 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19607 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19608 .cindex "shadow transport"
19609 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19610 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19611 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19613 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19614 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19615 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19616 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19617 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19618 cause a log line to be written.
19620 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19621 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19622 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19623 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19624 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19627 ST=<shadow transport name>
19629 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19630 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19631 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19632 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19633 headers that some sites insist on.
19636 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19637 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19638 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19639 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19640 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19641 individual users or via a system filter.
19643 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19644 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19645 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19646 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19647 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19649 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19650 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19651 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19652 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19653 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19654 &(pipe)& transports.
19656 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19657 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19658 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19659 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19660 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19662 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19663 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19664 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19665 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19667 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19668 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19669 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19670 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19671 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19672 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19674 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19675 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19676 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19677 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19678 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19679 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19680 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19681 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19683 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19684 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19685 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19686 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19687 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19688 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19689 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19690 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19691 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19692 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19695 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19696 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19697 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19698 which the message is being sent. For example:
19700 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19701 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19704 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19705 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19706 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19708 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19709 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19710 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19713 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19715 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19716 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19717 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19718 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19719 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19720 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19722 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19723 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19724 arguments. Consider this example:
19726 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19727 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19729 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19730 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19732 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19733 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19737 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19738 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19739 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19740 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19741 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19742 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19743 bounced from a transport filter.
19745 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19746 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19747 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19750 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19751 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19752 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19753 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19754 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19755 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19756 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19757 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19758 becomes a temporary error.
19761 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19762 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19763 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19764 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19765 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19766 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19767 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19770 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19771 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19772 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19774 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19775 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19776 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19777 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19779 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19780 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19781 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19791 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19793 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19794 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19795 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19796 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19797 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19798 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19799 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19801 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19802 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19803 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19804 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19805 local transport, for example:
19808 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19809 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19810 recipients saves space.
19812 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19813 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19815 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19816 to a scanner program or
19817 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19821 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19822 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19823 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19825 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19826 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19827 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19828 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19829 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19830 to certain conditions:
19833 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19834 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19835 batching is possible.
19837 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19838 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19839 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19841 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19842 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19843 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19844 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19845 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19848 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19849 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19850 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19854 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19855 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19856 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19857 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19858 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19859 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19860 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19863 escape_string = ".."
19865 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19866 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19867 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19869 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19870 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19871 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19872 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19873 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19874 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19876 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19877 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19878 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19879 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19880 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19881 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19882 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19883 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19884 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19892 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19893 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19894 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19895 .cindex "directory creation"
19896 .cindex "creating directories"
19897 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19898 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19899 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19900 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19901 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19902 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19903 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19904 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19905 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19906 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19908 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19909 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19910 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19913 .cindex "quota" "system"
19914 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19915 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19916 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19918 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19919 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19920 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19921 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19923 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19924 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19927 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19928 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19929 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19930 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19935 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19936 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19937 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19938 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19939 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19941 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19942 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19943 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19944 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19945 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19946 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19947 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19948 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19949 operation. There are two cases:
19952 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19953 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19954 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19955 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19956 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19957 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19958 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19960 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19961 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19962 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19966 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19967 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19968 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19969 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19974 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19976 require "fileinto";
19977 fileinto "folder23";
19979 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19980 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19981 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19982 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19983 way of handling this requirement:
19985 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19986 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19987 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19989 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19993 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19994 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19995 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19997 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19998 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19999 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20000 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20001 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20002 path to the transport.
20004 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20005 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20010 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20011 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20015 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20016 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20017 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20018 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20019 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20020 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20021 delivery is deferred.
20024 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20026 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20027 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20028 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20029 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20030 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20031 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20034 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20035 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20036 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20037 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20041 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20042 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20045 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20046 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20047 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20048 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20049 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20052 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20053 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20054 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20055 process is running.
20058 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20059 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20060 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20061 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20062 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20063 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20064 contains is significant.
20066 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20067 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20068 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20069 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20070 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20072 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20073 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20074 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20075 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20076 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20077 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20079 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20080 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20081 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20082 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20084 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20085 .cindex "directory creation"
20086 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20087 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20088 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20090 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20091 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20092 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20093 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20094 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20098 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20099 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20100 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20101 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20102 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20105 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20106 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20107 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20108 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20109 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20110 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20111 &%file_must_exist%&.
20114 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20115 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20116 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20117 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20119 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20120 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20121 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20122 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20123 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20126 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20128 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20129 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20130 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20131 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20133 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20135 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20136 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20140 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20141 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20142 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20145 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20146 See &%check_string%& above.
20149 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20150 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20151 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20152 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20153 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20154 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20157 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20158 .cindex "locking files"
20159 .cindex "lock files"
20160 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20161 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20163 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20164 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20167 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20168 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20171 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20172 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20173 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20174 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20175 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20176 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20180 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20181 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20182 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20183 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20184 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20185 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20186 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20187 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20188 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20191 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20192 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20194 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20195 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20196 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20197 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20198 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20199 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20200 delivery is deferred.
20203 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20204 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20205 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20206 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20209 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20210 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20211 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20212 .cindex "locking files"
20213 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20214 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20215 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20216 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20217 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20218 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20219 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20220 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20222 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20223 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20224 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20225 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20227 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20228 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20231 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20233 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20234 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20235 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20237 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20238 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20240 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20243 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20244 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20245 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20246 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20249 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20250 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20251 for details of locking.
20254 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20255 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20256 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20259 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20260 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20261 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20264 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20265 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20266 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20267 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20268 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20271 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20272 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20273 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20274 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20275 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20276 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20277 external source that maintains the data.
20280 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20281 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20282 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20283 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20284 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20285 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20286 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20287 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20291 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20292 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20293 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20294 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20295 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20296 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20297 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20298 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20299 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20300 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20303 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20304 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20305 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20306 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20307 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20308 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20309 calculation. The default value is:
20311 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20313 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20314 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20316 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20318 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20320 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20321 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20322 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20323 directly into that directory.
20326 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20327 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20328 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20331 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20332 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20333 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20337 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20338 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20339 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20340 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20341 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20342 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20343 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20344 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20347 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20348 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20349 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20350 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20351 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20352 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20353 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20354 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20355 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20356 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20359 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20360 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20361 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20362 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20363 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20364 below for further details.
20367 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20368 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20369 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20372 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20373 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20374 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20377 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20378 .cindex "locking files"
20379 .cindex "file" "locking"
20380 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20381 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20382 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20383 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20384 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20385 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20386 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20388 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20389 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20390 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20397 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20398 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20399 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20400 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20401 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20402 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20403 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20404 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20406 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20407 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20408 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20409 append messages to it.
20412 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20413 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20414 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20415 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20416 in which case it is:
20418 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20419 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20421 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20422 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20424 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20425 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20426 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20427 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20432 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20433 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20435 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20436 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20437 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20438 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20439 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20440 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20441 value, and this option is ignored.
20444 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20445 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20446 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20447 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20448 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20451 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20452 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20453 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20454 on users about incoming mail.
20457 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20458 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20459 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20460 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20461 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20462 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20463 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20464 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20465 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20467 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20468 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20469 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20471 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20472 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20473 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20474 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20475 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20476 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20478 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20479 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20480 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20481 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20484 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20486 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20487 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20488 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20489 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20490 system quota failures.
20492 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20493 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20494 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20495 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20496 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20497 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20498 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20499 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20500 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20501 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20504 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20505 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20506 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20507 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20508 delivery directory.
20511 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20512 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20513 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20514 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20515 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20519 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20520 See &%quota%& above.
20523 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20524 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20525 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20526 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20527 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20528 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20529 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20531 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20532 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20533 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20534 the file length to the file name. For example:
20536 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20537 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20539 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20540 number of lines in the message.
20542 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20543 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20544 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20546 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20549 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20550 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20551 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20553 quota_warn_message = "\
20554 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20555 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20556 This message is automatically created \
20557 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20558 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20559 a warning threshold that is\n\
20560 set by the system administrator.\n"
20564 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20565 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20566 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20567 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20568 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20569 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20570 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20571 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20572 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20576 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20578 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20579 percent sign is ignored.
20581 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20582 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20583 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20584 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20585 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20586 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20588 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20590 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20591 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20594 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20595 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20599 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20600 .cindex "envelope sender"
20601 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20602 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20603 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20604 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20605 for details of batch SMTP.
20608 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20609 .cindex "carriage return"
20611 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20612 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20613 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20614 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20616 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20617 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20618 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20619 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20620 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20621 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20624 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20625 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20626 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20627 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20628 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20629 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20632 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20633 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20634 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20635 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20636 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20638 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20639 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20640 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20641 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20643 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20644 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20645 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20646 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20647 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20650 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20651 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20654 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20655 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20656 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20657 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20658 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20659 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20660 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20662 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20663 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20664 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20665 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20668 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20669 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20670 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20673 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20674 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20675 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20676 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20677 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20678 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20679 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20680 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20681 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20683 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20684 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20685 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20686 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20691 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20692 .cindex "appending to a file"
20693 .cindex "file" "appending"
20694 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20697 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20701 .cindex "directory creation"
20702 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20703 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20704 &%directory_mode%& option.
20707 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20708 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20712 .cindex "file" "locking"
20713 .cindex "locking files"
20714 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20715 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20716 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20719 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20720 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20721 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20723 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20725 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20726 Unlink the hitching post name.
20728 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20729 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20730 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20731 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20733 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20734 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20735 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20736 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20737 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20738 it before trying again.
20742 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20743 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20744 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20747 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20748 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20749 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20750 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20751 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20752 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20753 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20754 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20755 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20759 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20760 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20761 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20762 delivery is deferred.
20765 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20766 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20767 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20771 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20772 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20773 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20776 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20777 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20778 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20781 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20782 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20783 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20784 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20785 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20786 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20787 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20788 that prevents link following.
20791 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20792 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20793 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20794 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20795 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20798 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20801 .cindex "file" "locking"
20802 .cindex "locking files"
20803 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20804 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20805 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20806 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20807 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20809 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20811 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20812 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20813 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20815 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20816 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20817 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20819 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20820 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20821 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20822 delivery is deferred.
20824 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20825 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20826 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20827 immediately. It retries up to
20829 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20831 times (rounded up).
20834 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20835 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20838 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20839 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20840 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20841 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20842 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20843 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20844 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20845 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20846 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20847 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20849 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20850 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20851 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20852 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20853 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20854 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20855 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20857 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20858 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20859 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20860 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20863 .cindex "maildir format"
20864 .cindex "mailstore format"
20865 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20866 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20867 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20868 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20869 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20871 .cindex "directory creation"
20872 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20873 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20874 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20875 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20876 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20877 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20882 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20883 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20884 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20885 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20886 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20887 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20888 &_new_& subdirectory.
20890 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20891 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20892 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20893 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20894 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20895 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20896 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20898 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20899 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20900 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20901 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20902 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20903 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20904 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20905 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20907 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20908 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20909 folders. Consider this example:
20911 maildir_format = true
20912 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20913 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20914 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20915 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20917 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20918 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20919 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20920 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20921 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20922 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20924 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20925 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20926 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20927 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20928 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20930 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20931 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20932 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20934 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20935 .cindex "maildir++"
20936 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20937 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20938 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20939 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20940 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20941 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20942 amount of space used.
20944 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20945 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20946 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20947 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20948 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20949 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20954 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20955 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20956 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20957 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20958 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20959 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20962 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20963 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20964 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20965 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20966 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20967 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20968 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20969 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20970 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20971 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
20972 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
20973 backwards compatibility).
20975 For one common implementation, you might set:
20977 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
20979 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
20981 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
20982 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
20983 &[stat()]& each message file.
20986 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20987 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20988 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20989 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20990 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20991 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20992 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20993 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20994 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20996 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20997 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20998 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20999 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21000 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21001 need to know the quota.
21003 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21004 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21006 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21007 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21008 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21012 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21013 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21014 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21015 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21016 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21017 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21018 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21019 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21021 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21022 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21023 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21024 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21025 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21026 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21028 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21029 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21030 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21031 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21032 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21033 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21035 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21036 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21037 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21038 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21041 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21042 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21043 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21044 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21045 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21047 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21049 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21050 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21051 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21052 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21053 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21063 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21064 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21065 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21066 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21067 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21068 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21069 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21070 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21072 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21073 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21074 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21075 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21076 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21079 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21080 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21081 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21082 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21083 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21085 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21086 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21087 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21088 transport is run as a consequence of a
21090 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21091 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21092 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21093 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21094 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21095 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21097 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21098 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21099 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21100 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21102 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21103 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21104 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21105 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21106 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21107 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21108 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21110 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21111 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21112 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21113 the transport defers.
21114 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21115 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21117 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21118 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21119 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21120 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21122 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21123 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21124 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21125 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21126 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21127 problems. They are just discarded.
21131 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21132 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21134 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21135 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21136 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21139 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21140 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21141 when the message is specified by the transport.
21144 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21145 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21146 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21147 string comes first.
21150 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21151 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21152 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21155 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21156 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21157 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21160 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21161 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21162 specified by the transport.
21165 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21166 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21167 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21168 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21171 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21172 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21173 the message is specified by the transport.
21176 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21177 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21181 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21182 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21183 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21184 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21185 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21189 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21190 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21191 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21192 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21194 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21195 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21196 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21197 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21198 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21199 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21200 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21203 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21204 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21205 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21206 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21207 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21209 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21210 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21211 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21212 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21213 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21214 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21217 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21218 See &%once%& above.
21221 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21222 See &%once%& above.
21223 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21226 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21227 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21228 specified by the transport.
21231 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21232 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21233 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21234 configuration option.
21237 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21238 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21239 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21240 automatic responses. For example:
21242 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21244 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21245 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21246 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21247 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21252 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21253 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21254 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21255 the text comes first.
21258 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21259 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21260 when the message is specified by the transport.
21261 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21262 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21270 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21271 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21272 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21273 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21274 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21275 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21277 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21278 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21279 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21280 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21281 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21282 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21286 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21287 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21288 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21291 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21292 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21295 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21296 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21297 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21298 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21299 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21302 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21303 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21304 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21305 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21306 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21307 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21310 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21311 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21312 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21313 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21314 in its response to the LHLO command.
21316 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21317 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21318 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21319 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21322 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21323 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21324 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21325 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21330 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21334 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21335 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21339 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21342 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21343 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21344 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21345 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21346 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21347 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21348 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21349 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21353 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21354 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21355 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21356 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21357 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21359 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21360 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21361 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21362 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21363 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21364 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21365 that are routed to the transport.
21367 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21368 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21369 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21370 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21371 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21372 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21373 the local part that was redirected.
21377 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21378 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21379 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21381 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21382 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21383 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21384 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21385 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21386 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21387 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21390 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21391 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21392 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21393 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21394 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21399 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21400 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21401 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21402 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21403 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21404 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21405 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21406 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21407 &"local delivery failed"&.
21409 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21410 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21411 will be sent as normal.
21413 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21414 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21415 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21416 apply in this case.
21418 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21419 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21420 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21421 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21423 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21424 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21425 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21426 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21427 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21428 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21429 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21434 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21435 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21436 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21437 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21438 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21441 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21442 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21443 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21444 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21446 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21447 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21448 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21449 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21450 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21452 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21454 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21455 arguments. You have to write
21457 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21459 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21460 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21461 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21462 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21463 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21464 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21467 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21470 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21471 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21472 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21473 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21474 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21475 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21476 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21477 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21478 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21479 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21481 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21482 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21483 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21484 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21485 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21486 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21487 control what is done with it.
21489 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21490 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21491 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21492 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21493 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21494 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21495 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21496 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21497 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21498 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21499 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21503 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21504 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21505 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21506 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21507 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21508 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21511 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21512 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21513 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21514 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21515 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21516 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21517 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21518 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21519 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21520 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21521 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21522 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21523 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21524 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21525 &`USER `& see below
21527 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21528 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21529 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21530 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21531 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21532 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21533 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21536 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21537 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21538 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21542 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21543 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21544 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21545 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21548 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21549 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21553 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21554 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21555 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21556 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21557 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21558 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21559 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21560 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21561 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21562 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21563 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21566 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21568 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21569 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21570 &%use_shell%& is set.
21573 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21574 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21577 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21578 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21579 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21582 .option check_string pipe string unset
21583 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21584 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21585 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21586 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21587 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21588 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21589 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21593 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21594 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21595 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21596 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21597 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21598 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21599 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21602 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21603 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21604 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21605 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21606 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21607 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21608 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21611 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21612 See &%check_string%& above.
21615 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21616 .cindex "exec failure"
21617 .cindex "failure of exec"
21618 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21619 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21620 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21621 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21622 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21625 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21626 .cindex "signal exit"
21627 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21628 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21629 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21630 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21633 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21634 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21635 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21636 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21637 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21638 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21640 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21641 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21643 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21644 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21645 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21646 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21647 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21650 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21651 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21652 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21653 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21654 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21655 Only one of them may be set.
21659 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21660 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21661 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21662 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21666 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21667 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21668 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21669 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21670 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21671 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21672 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21673 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21676 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21677 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21678 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21681 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21685 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21686 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21687 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21688 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21689 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21694 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21695 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21698 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21699 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21700 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21701 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21705 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21706 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21709 .option path pipe string "see below"
21710 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21711 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21715 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21716 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21717 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21720 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21721 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21722 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21723 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21724 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21725 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21726 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21727 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21728 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21731 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21732 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21733 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21734 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21735 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21736 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21737 accept the message is used.
21740 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21741 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21742 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21743 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21744 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21745 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21748 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21749 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21750 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21751 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21752 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21753 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21754 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21758 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21759 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21760 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21761 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21762 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21763 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21764 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21765 of them may be set.
21769 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21770 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21771 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21772 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21773 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21774 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21775 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21776 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21777 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21778 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21779 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21780 and 73, respectively.
21783 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21784 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21785 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21786 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21787 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21788 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21789 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21791 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21792 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21793 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21794 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21795 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21796 delivery to be deferred.
21798 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21799 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21802 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21803 .cindex "envelope sender"
21804 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21805 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21806 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21807 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21808 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21810 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21811 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21812 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21813 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21814 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21815 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21819 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21820 .cindex "carriage return"
21822 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21823 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21824 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21825 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21827 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21828 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21829 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21830 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21831 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21834 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21835 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21836 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21837 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21838 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21839 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21840 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21841 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21842 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21847 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21848 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21849 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21850 .cindex "external local delivery"
21851 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21852 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21853 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21854 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21855 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21856 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21857 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21858 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21859 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21860 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21865 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21869 check_string = "From "
21870 escape_string = ">From "
21879 transport = procmail_pipe
21881 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21882 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21883 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21884 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21885 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21886 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21888 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21892 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21893 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21896 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21897 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21900 local_delivery_cyrus:
21902 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21903 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21915 local_part_suffix = .*
21916 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21918 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21919 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21921 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21922 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21928 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21929 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21930 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21931 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21932 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21933 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21934 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21935 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21938 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21939 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21943 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21944 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21945 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21946 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21947 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21948 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21949 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21951 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21952 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21953 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21954 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21955 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21956 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21961 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21962 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21963 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21967 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21969 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21970 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21971 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21972 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21973 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21974 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21975 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21976 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21979 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21980 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
21981 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21982 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21983 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
21984 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
21985 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
21986 are the values that were set when the message was received.
21987 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21988 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
21989 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21990 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21991 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21992 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21995 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21996 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21997 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22000 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22001 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22002 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22003 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22004 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22005 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22006 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22007 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22009 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22010 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22011 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22012 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22013 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22014 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22015 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22016 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22017 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22020 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22022 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22023 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22024 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22025 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22026 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22029 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22030 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22031 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22032 particular connection.
22034 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22035 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22036 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22037 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22039 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22040 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22041 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22043 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22045 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22046 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22048 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22049 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22053 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22054 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22055 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22056 authenticated as a client.
22059 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22060 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22061 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22062 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22065 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22066 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22067 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22068 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22069 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22070 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22071 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22074 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22075 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22076 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22077 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22078 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22079 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22080 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22084 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22085 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22086 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22087 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22090 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22091 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22092 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22095 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22096 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22097 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22098 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22099 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22100 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22102 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22103 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22104 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22105 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22106 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22107 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22108 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22109 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22113 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22114 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22115 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22116 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22117 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22120 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22121 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22122 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22123 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22128 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22129 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22130 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22131 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22132 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22133 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22134 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22135 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22137 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22138 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22139 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22140 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22141 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22142 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22144 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22145 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22146 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22147 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22148 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22150 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22151 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22152 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22153 copy of the message is sent.
22155 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22156 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22157 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22158 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22162 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22163 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22164 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22167 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22168 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22169 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22170 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22171 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22172 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22174 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22175 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22176 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22177 implementations of TLS.
22179 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22180 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22181 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22182 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22183 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22184 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22185 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22190 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22191 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22192 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22193 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22194 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22195 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22196 interface address, you could use this:
22198 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22199 {$primary_hostname}}
22201 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22204 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22205 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22206 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22207 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22208 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22209 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22211 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22212 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22213 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22214 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22216 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22217 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22218 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22219 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22220 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22221 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22222 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22224 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22225 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22226 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22227 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22228 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22229 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22230 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22233 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22234 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22237 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22238 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22239 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22240 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22241 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22242 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22243 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22244 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22245 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22246 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22249 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22250 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22251 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22252 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22255 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22256 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22257 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22258 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22261 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22262 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22263 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22264 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22265 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22266 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22267 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22268 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22271 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22272 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22273 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22278 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22279 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22280 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22281 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22282 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22283 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22284 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22285 explanation of when this might be needed.
22288 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22289 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22290 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22291 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22292 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22295 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22296 .cindex "randomized host list"
22297 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22298 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22299 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22300 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22301 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22302 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22303 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22304 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22306 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22307 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22308 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22309 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22311 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22313 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22314 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22315 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22317 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22318 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22319 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22320 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22321 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22322 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22323 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22324 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22325 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22328 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22329 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22330 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22331 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22332 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22333 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22335 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22336 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22337 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22338 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22339 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22340 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22341 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22343 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22344 .cindex "bind IP address"
22345 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22347 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22348 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22349 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22350 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22351 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22352 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22353 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22354 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22357 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22358 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22359 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22360 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22361 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22362 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22364 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22366 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22367 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22368 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22369 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22372 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22373 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22374 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22375 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22376 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22377 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22378 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22379 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22380 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22381 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22385 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22386 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22387 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22388 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22389 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22391 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22392 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22393 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22394 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22395 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22399 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22400 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22401 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22402 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22403 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22404 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22405 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22406 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22409 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22410 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22411 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22412 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22413 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22414 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22415 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22416 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22418 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22419 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22420 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22421 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22426 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22427 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22428 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22429 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22431 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22432 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22433 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22434 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22435 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22438 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22439 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22440 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22441 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22445 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22446 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22447 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22448 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22449 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22450 addresses is not affected.
22452 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22453 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22454 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22455 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22456 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22460 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22461 .cindex "serializing connections"
22462 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22463 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22464 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22465 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22466 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22467 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22468 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22470 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22471 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22472 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22473 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22474 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22475 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22477 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22478 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22479 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22480 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22481 are used for ETRN serialization.
22484 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22485 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22486 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22487 .cindex "size" "of message"
22488 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22489 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22490 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22491 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22492 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22493 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22494 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22495 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22497 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22498 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22501 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22502 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22503 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22505 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22506 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22507 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22508 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22509 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22512 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22513 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22514 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22515 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22519 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22520 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22521 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22522 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22523 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22526 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22527 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22529 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22530 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22531 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22532 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22533 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22534 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22535 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22536 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22539 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22540 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22541 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22543 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22544 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22545 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22546 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22547 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22548 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22549 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22550 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22551 ciphers is a preference order.
22556 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22557 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22558 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22559 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_sni variable and causes any
22560 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22561 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22562 certificate and private key for the session.
22564 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22566 OpenSSL only, also requiring a build of OpenSSL that supports TLS extensions.
22571 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22572 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22573 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22574 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22575 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22576 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22577 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22578 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22579 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22580 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22584 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22585 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22586 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22588 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22589 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22590 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22591 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22592 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22593 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22594 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22595 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22596 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22601 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22603 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22604 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22605 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22606 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22607 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22610 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22611 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22612 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22613 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22616 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22617 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22618 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22620 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22621 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22622 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22623 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22624 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22626 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22627 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22628 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22629 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22630 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22631 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22632 see below for an exception).
22634 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22635 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22636 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22637 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22638 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22640 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22641 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22642 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22643 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22644 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22645 reached their retry times.
22647 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22648 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22649 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22650 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22651 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22652 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22653 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22654 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22655 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22656 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22659 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22660 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22661 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22662 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22663 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22664 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22666 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22667 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22668 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22669 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22670 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22671 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22680 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22681 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22682 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22683 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22684 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22685 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22687 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22688 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22689 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22690 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22691 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22692 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22693 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22695 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22696 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22697 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22698 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22701 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22702 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22703 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22704 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22706 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22707 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22708 facility; you do not have to use it.
22710 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22711 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22712 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22713 address to which it applies.
22715 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22716 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22717 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22718 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22719 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22720 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22723 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22724 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22725 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22726 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22729 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22730 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22731 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22732 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22733 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22736 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22737 illustrated by these examples:
22740 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22741 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22742 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22743 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22745 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22746 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22751 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22752 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22753 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22754 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22755 message's processing.
22757 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22758 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22759 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22760 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22761 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22762 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22763 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22764 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22765 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22767 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22768 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22769 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22770 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22771 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22772 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22773 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22774 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22775 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22776 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22778 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22779 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22780 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22781 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22782 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22783 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22785 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22786 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22787 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22789 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22790 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22791 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22792 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22793 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22794 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22795 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22796 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22797 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22799 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22800 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22806 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22807 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22808 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22809 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22810 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22811 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22812 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22813 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22814 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22815 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22817 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22819 might produce the output
22821 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22822 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22823 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22824 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22825 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22826 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22827 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22828 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22830 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22831 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22832 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22833 set for a particular transport.
22836 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22837 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22838 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22841 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22843 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22844 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22845 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22846 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22848 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22849 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22850 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22851 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22854 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22855 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22856 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22858 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22859 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22860 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22861 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22862 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22863 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22864 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22866 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22867 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22868 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22869 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22870 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22874 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22875 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22878 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22879 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22880 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22881 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22882 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22883 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22884 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22885 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22886 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22888 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22889 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22890 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22892 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22893 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22894 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22895 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22896 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22897 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22898 of pattern they are set as follows:
22901 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22902 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22903 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22906 *queen@*.fict.example
22908 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22910 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22914 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22915 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22918 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22919 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22920 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22921 rewriting rule of the form
22923 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22925 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22931 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22932 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22933 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22934 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22935 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22939 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22940 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22941 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22942 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22943 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22945 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22947 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22950 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22951 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22952 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22953 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22954 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22955 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22956 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22957 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22958 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22959 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22960 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22961 entry written to the panic log.
22965 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22966 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22969 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22972 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22974 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22977 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22978 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22982 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22984 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22985 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22986 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22987 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22988 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22989 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22991 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22992 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22993 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22994 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22995 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22996 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22997 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22998 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22999 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23000 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23002 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23003 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23004 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23006 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23007 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23010 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23011 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23012 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23013 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23014 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23015 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23016 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23017 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23018 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23020 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23021 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23022 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23023 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23024 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23025 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23026 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23027 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23030 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23031 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23032 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23033 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23036 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23037 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23038 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23040 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23041 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23042 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23043 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23045 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23046 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23047 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23049 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23050 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23051 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23052 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23054 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23058 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23061 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23062 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23063 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23064 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23065 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23066 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23067 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23068 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23070 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23071 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23075 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23076 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23078 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23079 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23080 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23082 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23083 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23084 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23085 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23086 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23087 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23088 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23089 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23091 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23092 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23094 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23096 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23097 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23099 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23100 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23101 messages that originate outside the local host:
23103 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23104 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23106 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23109 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23110 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23111 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23112 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23113 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23114 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23115 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23116 components. For example, the rule
23118 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23120 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23121 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23122 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23123 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23124 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23125 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23126 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23136 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23137 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23138 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23139 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23140 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23141 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23142 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23143 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23144 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23145 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23146 address, domain and error.
23148 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23149 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23150 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23151 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23152 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23153 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23154 log selector is set, the message
23155 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23156 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23157 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23158 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23160 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23161 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23162 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23163 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23164 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23165 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23166 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23167 domain are maintained independently.
23169 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23170 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23171 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23172 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23173 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23174 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23175 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23176 the local address is reached.
23178 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23179 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23180 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23181 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23182 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23184 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23185 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23186 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23187 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23188 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23189 messages that it should now be retaining.
23193 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23194 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23195 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23196 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23197 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23198 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23199 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23200 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23201 message's sender, respectively.
23204 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23205 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23206 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23207 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23208 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23209 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23212 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23214 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23217 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23219 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23220 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23223 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23224 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23225 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23226 expressions work in address lists.
23228 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23229 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23233 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23234 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23235 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23236 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23237 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23238 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23239 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23240 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23241 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23243 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23244 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23245 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23246 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23249 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23250 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23251 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23252 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23253 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23254 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23255 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23256 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23257 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23258 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23263 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23265 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23266 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23267 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23268 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23269 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23270 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23272 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23276 and the retry rules are
23278 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23279 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23281 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23282 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23283 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23284 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23285 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23286 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23288 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23289 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23290 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23291 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23293 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23294 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23295 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23297 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23299 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23300 textual form of the IP address.
23302 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23303 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23304 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23305 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23308 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23309 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23310 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23312 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23313 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23314 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23316 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23317 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23319 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23320 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23323 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23324 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23325 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23326 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23327 retry rule of this form:
23329 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23331 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23332 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23335 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23336 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23337 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23338 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23340 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23341 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23343 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23344 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23347 A connection was refused.
23349 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23350 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23352 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23353 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23355 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23356 A connection attempt timed out.
23358 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23359 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23360 obtained from an MX record.
23362 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23363 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23364 obtained from an MX record.
23367 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23369 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23370 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23371 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23372 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23375 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23378 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23379 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23380 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23381 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23382 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23383 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23387 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23388 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23389 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23390 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23391 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23395 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23396 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23397 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23399 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23400 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23401 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23402 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23403 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23404 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23405 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23407 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23408 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23411 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23412 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23413 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23418 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23419 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23420 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23421 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23422 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23425 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23427 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23429 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23431 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23432 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23435 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23437 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23438 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23439 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23440 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23441 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23443 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23444 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23446 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23448 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23449 list is never matched.
23455 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23456 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23457 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23458 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23460 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23462 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23463 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23464 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23465 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23466 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23468 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23469 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23470 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23471 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23472 The available algorithms are:
23475 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23478 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23479 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23480 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23482 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23483 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23484 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23485 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23486 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23487 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23488 queue processing times.
23491 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23492 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23493 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23494 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23495 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23496 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23497 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23498 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23499 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23500 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23501 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23502 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23504 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23505 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23506 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23507 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23508 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23509 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23512 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23513 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23514 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23515 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23516 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23517 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23518 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23519 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23520 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23521 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23522 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23523 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23525 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23526 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23527 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23528 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23529 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23530 deliveries that have been deferred.
23533 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23534 Here are some example retry rules:
23536 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23537 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23538 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23539 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23540 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23541 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23543 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23544 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23545 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23546 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23547 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23548 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23549 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23552 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23553 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23554 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23555 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23556 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23558 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23559 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23560 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23561 were not obtained from an MX record.
23563 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23564 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23565 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23566 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23567 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23571 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23572 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23573 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23574 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23575 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23576 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23577 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23578 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23579 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23580 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23581 failing for the first time.
23583 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23584 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23585 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23586 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23588 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23589 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23590 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23595 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23596 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23597 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23598 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23599 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23600 default retry rule:
23602 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23604 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23605 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23606 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23608 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23609 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23610 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23611 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23612 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23614 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23615 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23616 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23618 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23619 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23620 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23621 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23622 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23623 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23624 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23625 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23627 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23628 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23629 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23630 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23631 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23634 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23635 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23636 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23637 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23638 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23639 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23640 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23641 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23642 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23645 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23646 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23647 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23648 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23649 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23650 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23651 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23652 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23655 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23656 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23657 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23658 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23659 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23660 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23661 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23662 time out the address.
23664 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23665 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23666 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23667 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23668 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23669 considered immediately.
23670 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23671 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23681 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23682 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23683 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23684 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23685 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23686 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23687 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23688 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23689 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23692 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23693 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23696 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23697 the client's EHLO command.
23699 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23700 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23702 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23703 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23704 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23705 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23706 with the AUTH command.
23708 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23710 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23711 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23712 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23715 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23716 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23717 unauthenticated connection.
23720 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23721 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23722 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23723 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23725 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23726 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23727 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23728 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23729 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23730 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23731 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23732 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23737 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23738 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23739 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23740 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23741 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23742 included by setting
23745 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23749 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23754 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23755 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23756 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23758 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23759 work via a socket interface.
23760 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23761 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23762 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23763 supporting setting a server keytab.
23764 The sixth can be configured to support
23765 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23766 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23767 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23770 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23771 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23772 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23773 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23774 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23775 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23776 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23778 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23779 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23780 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23781 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23782 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23783 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23787 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23788 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23790 client_secret = secret2
23792 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23793 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23795 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23796 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23797 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23801 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23802 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23803 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23804 authenticating data.
23806 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23807 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23808 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23809 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23810 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23811 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23812 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23813 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23814 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23815 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23818 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23819 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23820 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23821 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23826 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23827 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23828 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23830 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23831 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23832 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23833 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23834 encrypted by a setting such as:
23836 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23838 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23839 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23840 cipher used for the delivery.)
23843 .option driver authenticators string unset
23844 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23845 authenticators is to be used.
23848 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23849 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23850 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23851 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23852 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23853 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23856 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23857 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23858 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23859 mechanism is not advertised.
23860 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23861 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23862 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23865 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23866 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23867 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23871 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23872 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23875 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23876 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23877 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23878 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23879 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23880 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23881 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23882 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23883 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23887 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23888 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23889 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23890 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23891 out the values of variables.
23892 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23893 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23896 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23897 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23898 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23899 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23900 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23901 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23902 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23903 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23904 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23907 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23908 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23909 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23910 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23911 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23912 remembered for later use.
23913 How it is used is described in the following section.
23919 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23920 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23921 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23922 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23923 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23927 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23928 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23930 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23932 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23933 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23934 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23935 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23936 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23937 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23938 given for the MAIL command.
23940 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23941 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23944 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23945 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23946 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23947 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23948 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23949 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23950 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23955 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23956 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23957 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23958 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23960 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23961 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23962 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23963 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23964 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23969 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23970 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23971 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23972 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23976 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23978 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23979 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23982 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23983 the mechanisms are advertised.
23985 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23986 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23987 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23988 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23989 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23990 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23991 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23993 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23995 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23997 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23998 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23999 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24002 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24004 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24005 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24006 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24008 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24009 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24010 command. This is the case if
24013 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24015 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24017 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24018 server authenticators.
24022 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24023 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24024 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24026 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24027 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24028 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24029 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24030 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24031 rejected with a 504 error.
24033 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24034 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24035 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24036 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24037 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24038 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24039 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24040 no successful authentication.
24045 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24046 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24047 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24048 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24049 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24050 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24051 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24055 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24057 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24058 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24059 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24060 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24061 command line to run this script on such data might be
24063 encode '\0user\0password'
24065 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24066 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24067 whose code value is zero.
24069 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24070 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24071 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24072 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24074 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24075 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24076 example, a command such as
24078 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24080 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24082 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24083 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24085 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24087 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24088 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24089 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24090 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24094 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24095 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24096 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24097 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24098 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24099 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24102 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24103 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24104 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24105 of the authenticator.
24108 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24109 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24110 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24111 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24112 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24113 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24114 delivery to be deferred.
24116 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24117 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24118 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24121 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24122 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24123 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24124 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24125 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24126 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24127 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24128 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24129 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24132 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24133 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24134 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24135 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24136 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24137 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24138 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24139 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24140 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24141 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24142 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24143 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24144 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24154 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24155 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24156 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24157 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24158 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24159 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24160 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24161 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24162 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24163 connections as you do for login accounts.
24165 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24166 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24167 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24169 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24170 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24171 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24173 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24174 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24175 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24178 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24179 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24180 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24181 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24182 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24183 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24184 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24186 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24187 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24188 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24189 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24190 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24191 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24192 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24194 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24195 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24196 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24197 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24199 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24200 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24201 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24203 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24204 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24205 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24206 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24207 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24208 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24209 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24210 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24211 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24212 string as the error text.
24214 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24215 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24216 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24220 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24221 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24222 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24223 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24224 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24225 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24226 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24227 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24229 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24230 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24231 configured as follows:
24235 public_name = PLAIN
24237 server_condition = \
24238 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24239 server_set_id = $auth2
24241 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24242 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24243 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24244 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24246 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24247 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24248 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24249 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24253 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24255 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24257 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24258 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24262 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24263 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24265 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24266 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24267 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24268 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24269 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24271 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24272 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24273 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24275 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24276 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24277 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24278 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24279 This is an incorrect example:
24281 server_condition = \
24282 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24284 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24285 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24286 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24287 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24288 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24289 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24290 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24292 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24293 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24295 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24296 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24297 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24298 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24299 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24302 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24303 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24304 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24305 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24306 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24307 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24308 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24312 public_name = LOGIN
24313 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24314 server_condition = \
24315 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24316 server_set_id = $auth1
24318 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24319 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24320 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24321 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24323 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24324 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24325 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24326 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24327 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24331 public_name = LOGIN
24332 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24333 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24336 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24337 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24338 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24339 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24341 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24342 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24343 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24344 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24345 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24346 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24347 uninterpreted string.
24350 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24351 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24352 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24353 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24354 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24360 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24361 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24362 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24364 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24365 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24366 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24367 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24370 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24371 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24372 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24373 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24374 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24375 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24376 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24377 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24378 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24379 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24380 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24381 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24383 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24384 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24386 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24387 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24388 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24389 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24392 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24393 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24397 public_name = PLAIN
24398 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24400 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24401 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24402 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24406 public_name = LOGIN
24407 client_send = : username : mysecret
24409 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24410 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24412 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24413 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24421 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24422 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24423 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24424 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24425 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24426 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24427 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24428 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24429 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24430 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24431 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24432 available in plain text at either end.
24435 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24436 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24437 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24438 authenticator as a server:
24440 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24441 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24442 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24443 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24444 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24445 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24446 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24447 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24448 returned to the client.
24450 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24451 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24452 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24453 numeric variables for other things.
24455 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24456 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24457 user name, authentication fails.
24461 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24462 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24463 server_set_id = $auth1
24465 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24466 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24467 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24468 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24472 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24473 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24475 server_set_id = $auth1
24477 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24478 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24481 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24482 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24483 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24488 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24489 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24490 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24491 server_set_id = $auth1
24495 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24496 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24497 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24501 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24502 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24503 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24506 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24507 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24508 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24512 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24513 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24514 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24515 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24516 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24517 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24518 send the message to the current server.
24520 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24525 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24527 client_secret = secret
24529 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24530 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24537 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24538 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24539 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24540 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24542 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24543 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24545 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24546 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24547 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24548 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24549 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24551 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24552 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24553 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24554 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24556 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24557 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24558 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24559 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24560 depending on the driver you are using.
24562 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24563 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24564 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24565 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24566 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24569 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24570 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24571 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24572 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24573 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24574 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24575 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24576 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24580 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24581 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24582 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24583 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24584 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24585 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24589 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24590 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24591 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24592 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24595 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24596 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24597 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24598 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24602 driver = cyrus_sasl
24603 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24604 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24605 server_set_id = $auth1
24609 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24610 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24614 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24615 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24618 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24619 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24620 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24621 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24624 driver = cyrus_sasl
24625 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24626 server_set_id = $auth1
24629 driver = cyrus_sasl
24630 public_name = PLAIN
24631 server_set_id = $auth2
24633 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24634 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24635 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24636 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24637 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24642 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24644 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24645 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24646 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24647 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24648 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24649 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24650 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24651 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24653 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24655 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24656 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24657 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24658 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24662 public_name = PLAIN
24663 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24664 server_set_id = $auth2
24669 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24670 server_set_id = $auth1
24672 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24673 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24674 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24675 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24676 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24677 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24678 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24679 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24685 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24686 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24687 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24688 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24689 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24690 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24691 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24692 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24693 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24694 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24695 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24696 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24697 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24698 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24699 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24700 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24701 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24702 without code changes in Exim.
24705 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24706 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24707 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24708 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24709 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24712 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24713 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24714 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24716 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24717 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24718 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24720 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24721 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24722 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24725 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24726 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24727 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24728 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24731 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24732 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24733 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24734 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24739 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24740 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24741 server_set_id = $auth1
24745 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24746 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24747 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24748 the password itself.
24750 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24751 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24752 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24753 if available, else the empty string.
24754 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24755 else the empty string.
24757 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24759 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24760 option to be simply "true".
24763 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24764 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24765 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24768 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24769 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24770 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24771 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24774 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24775 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24776 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24777 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24780 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24781 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24782 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24785 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24786 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24787 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24788 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24790 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24791 meanings for these variables:
24794 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24795 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24797 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24798 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24800 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24801 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24804 On a per-mechanism basis:
24807 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24808 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24809 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24811 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24812 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24813 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24815 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24816 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24817 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24818 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24821 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24822 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24823 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24826 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24827 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24829 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24831 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24832 server_realm = imap.example.org
24833 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24834 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24835 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24836 server_condition = yes
24841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24845 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24846 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24847 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24848 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24849 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24850 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24851 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24854 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24855 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24856 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24857 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24859 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24860 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24861 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24862 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24864 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24865 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24866 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24870 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24871 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24872 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24873 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24875 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24876 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24877 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24878 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24880 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24882 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24883 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24885 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24886 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
24887 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
24893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24896 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24897 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24898 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24899 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24900 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24901 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24902 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24903 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24904 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24905 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24906 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24907 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24908 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24912 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24913 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24915 The server sends back a challenge.
24917 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24918 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24921 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24925 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24926 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24927 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24929 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24930 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24931 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24932 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24933 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24934 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24935 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24936 for other things. For example:
24941 server_password = \
24942 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24944 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24945 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24951 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24952 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24953 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24957 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24958 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24961 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24962 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24965 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24966 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24967 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24973 client_username = msn/msn_username
24974 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24975 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24977 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24978 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24987 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24988 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24989 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24990 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24991 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24994 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24995 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24996 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24997 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24998 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24999 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25000 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25001 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25002 certificates are used.
25004 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25005 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25006 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25007 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25008 between them is encrypted.
25010 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25011 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25012 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25013 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25016 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25017 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25018 in order to get TLS to work.
25022 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25024 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25025 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25026 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25027 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25028 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25029 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25030 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25031 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25032 allocated for this purpose.
25034 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25035 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25036 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25037 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25039 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25041 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25042 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25043 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25044 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25045 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25048 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25049 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25056 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25057 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25058 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25059 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25060 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25064 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25068 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25069 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25071 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25074 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25075 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25078 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25081 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25082 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25083 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25084 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
25086 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25087 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25088 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25089 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25090 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25091 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25092 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25095 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25096 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25099 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25100 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25101 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25102 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25107 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25109 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25110 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25111 but not the chosen filename.
25112 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25113 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25115 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25116 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25117 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25118 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25120 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25121 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25122 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25123 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25124 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25125 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25126 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25128 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25129 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25130 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25131 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25132 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25134 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25135 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25136 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25137 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25138 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25139 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25141 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25142 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25143 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25145 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25146 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25147 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25148 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25151 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25154 # chown exim:exim new-params
25155 # chmod 0600 new-params
25156 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25157 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25158 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25159 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25160 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25161 # chmod 0400 new-params
25162 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25164 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25165 stalling is removed.
25167 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25168 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25169 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25170 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25171 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25172 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25173 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25174 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25175 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25176 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25177 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25179 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25180 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25181 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25182 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25184 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25185 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25186 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25187 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25188 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25192 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25193 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25194 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25195 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25196 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25197 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25198 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25199 directly to this function call.
25200 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25201 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25202 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25203 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25206 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25208 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25209 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25210 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25213 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25214 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25215 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25219 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25222 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25223 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25226 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25227 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25229 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25230 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25233 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25234 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25235 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25236 not be moved to the end of the list.
25240 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25243 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25244 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25247 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25248 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25249 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25250 choice of clients used:
25252 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25253 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25262 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25264 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25265 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25266 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25267 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25268 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25269 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25270 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25271 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25272 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25273 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25275 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25277 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25278 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25279 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25280 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25281 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25282 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25284 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25285 "Priority strings". This is online as
25286 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25287 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25288 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25289 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25290 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25292 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25293 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25294 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25296 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25297 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25298 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25299 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25303 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25310 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25311 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25312 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25313 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25314 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25315 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25316 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25317 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25319 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25320 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25321 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25324 554 Security failure
25326 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25327 rejected with a 554 error code.
25329 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25330 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25331 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25332 without some further configuration at the server end.
25334 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25335 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25337 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25338 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25340 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25341 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25342 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25343 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25344 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25345 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25346 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25347 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25348 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25349 the server's certificate.
25351 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25352 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25353 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25355 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25356 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25357 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25360 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25361 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25362 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25364 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25366 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25367 with the parameters contained in the file.
25369 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25374 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25375 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25376 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25377 documetnation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25383 for a way of generating file data.
25386 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25387 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25388 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25389 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25390 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25392 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25393 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25394 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
25395 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25396 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25397 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25398 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25399 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25400 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25401 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
25404 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25405 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25406 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25407 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25408 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25409 documentation for more details.
25412 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25413 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25414 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25415 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25416 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25417 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25418 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25419 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25420 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25421 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25422 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25423 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25425 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25428 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25429 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25430 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25432 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25434 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25436 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25437 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25438 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25439 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25440 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25441 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25442 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25443 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25444 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25445 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25447 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25448 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25449 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25450 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25452 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25453 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25454 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25455 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25456 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25457 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
25460 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25461 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25462 .cindex "revocation list"
25463 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25464 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25465 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25466 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25467 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25468 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25472 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25473 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25474 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25475 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25476 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25477 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25478 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25479 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25480 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25482 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25483 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25484 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25485 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25486 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25488 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25489 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25490 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25491 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25492 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25495 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25496 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25497 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25498 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25499 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25500 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25501 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25502 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25503 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25504 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25507 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25508 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25509 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25510 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25512 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25513 must name a file or,
25514 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25515 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25516 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25517 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25520 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25521 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25522 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25523 alternative hosts, if any.
25526 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25527 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25528 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25532 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25533 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25534 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25535 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25536 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25538 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25539 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25540 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25541 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25542 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25543 &$tls_bits$&, &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25544 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25545 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25546 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25547 outgoing connection.
25552 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25553 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25554 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25555 .oindex "&%tls_sni%&"
25556 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25557 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25558 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25559 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25560 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25561 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25564 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25565 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25568 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25569 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25570 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25571 be of limited use in that environment.
25573 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25574 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25575 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25576 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25577 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25579 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25580 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25581 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25582 only point of caution. The &$tls_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25583 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25585 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_sni$& is set then it is a string
25586 received from a client.
25587 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25589 If the string &`tls_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25590 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25591 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25594 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25595 &%tls_certificate%&
25597 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25600 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25603 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25604 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25607 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25608 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25609 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25610 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25612 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25615 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25616 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25617 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25618 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25620 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25621 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25622 built, then you have SNI support).
25627 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25629 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25630 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25631 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25632 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25633 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25634 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25635 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25636 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25637 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25638 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25639 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25641 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25642 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25643 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25644 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25645 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25646 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25647 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25648 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25649 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25651 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25652 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25653 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25654 information is recorded.
25656 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25657 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25658 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25663 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25664 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25665 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25666 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25667 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25668 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25669 to Apache, currently at
25671 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25673 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25674 links to further files.
25675 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25676 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25677 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25679 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25683 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25684 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25685 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25686 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25687 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25688 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25689 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25690 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25691 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25692 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25693 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25694 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25695 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25698 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25699 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25700 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25701 with OpenSSL, like this:
25703 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25706 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25707 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25708 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25709 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25710 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25711 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25712 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25714 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25715 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25716 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25718 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25719 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25720 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25721 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25722 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25723 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25725 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25726 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25727 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25728 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25729 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25730 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25737 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25738 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25739 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25740 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25741 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25742 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25743 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25744 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25745 one very small ACL:
25749 accept hosts = one.host.only
25751 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25752 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25754 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25755 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25756 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25757 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25758 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25759 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25760 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25761 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25764 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25765 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25766 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25767 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25768 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25772 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25773 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25774 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25775 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25776 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25777 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25778 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25779 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25780 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25781 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25782 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25783 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25784 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25785 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25786 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25787 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25788 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25789 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25792 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25793 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25794 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25795 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25796 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25797 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25798 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25799 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25800 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25801 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25802 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25803 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25804 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25805 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25806 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25807 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25808 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25809 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25812 For example, if you set
25814 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25816 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25817 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25818 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25819 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25820 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25821 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25822 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25825 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25826 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25827 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25828 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25829 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25830 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25831 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25832 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25833 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25834 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25835 in any of these ACLs.
25837 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25838 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25839 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25840 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25841 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25842 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25843 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25844 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25846 control = suppress_local_fixups
25848 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25849 run, it is too late.
25851 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25852 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25854 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25855 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25856 temporary error for these kinds of message.
25859 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25860 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25861 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25862 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25863 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25864 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25865 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25866 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25867 &%smtp_banner%& option.
25870 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25871 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25872 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25873 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25874 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25875 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25876 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25877 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25878 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25880 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25881 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25882 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25883 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25887 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25888 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25889 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25890 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25891 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25892 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25893 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25894 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25895 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25896 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25898 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25899 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25900 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25901 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25902 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25903 associated with the DATA command.
25905 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25906 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25907 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25908 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25909 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25913 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25914 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25915 enabled (which is the default).
25917 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25918 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25919 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25921 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25924 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25925 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25926 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25929 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25930 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25931 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25932 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25933 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25934 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25936 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25937 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25938 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25939 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25941 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25942 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25944 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25945 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25948 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25949 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25950 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25951 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25952 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25955 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25956 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25957 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25958 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25959 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25960 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25961 situation even worse.
25963 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25964 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25965 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25968 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
25969 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
25970 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
25971 connection. The possible values are:
25973 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
25974 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
25975 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
25976 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
25977 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
25978 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
25979 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
25980 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
25981 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
25982 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
25984 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
25985 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
25986 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
25987 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
25988 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
25992 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
25993 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
25994 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
25995 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
25997 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
25998 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26000 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26001 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26002 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26003 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26004 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26006 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26007 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26008 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26011 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26012 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26013 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26014 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26015 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26016 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26018 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26019 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26020 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26022 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26023 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26024 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26025 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26027 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26028 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26029 matches the string.
26031 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26032 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26033 want to have something like
26035 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26037 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26038 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26044 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26045 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26046 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26047 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26048 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26049 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26050 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26051 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26052 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26054 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26055 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26056 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26059 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26060 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26061 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26062 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26064 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26065 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26066 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26067 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26068 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26069 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26070 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26073 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26074 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26075 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26079 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26080 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26081 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26082 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26083 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26084 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26086 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26087 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26088 used to accept or reject anything.
26090 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26091 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26092 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26093 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26095 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26096 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26097 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26098 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26099 configuration file.
26104 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26105 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26107 .vindex &$local_part$&
26108 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26109 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26110 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26111 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26112 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26113 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26114 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26115 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26116 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26118 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26119 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26120 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26123 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26124 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26125 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26126 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26127 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26130 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26131 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26132 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26133 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26134 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26135 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26136 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26137 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26143 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26144 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26145 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26146 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26147 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26148 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26149 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26150 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26151 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26152 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26153 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26154 unencrypted connections.
26157 accept encrypted = *
26158 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26160 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26162 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26163 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26164 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26165 option to do this.)
26169 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26170 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26171 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26172 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26173 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26174 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26175 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26177 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26178 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26179 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26182 deny dnslists = list1.example
26183 dnslists = list2.example
26185 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26186 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26187 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26188 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26189 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26192 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26193 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26196 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26197 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26198 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26199 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26200 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26201 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26202 check a RCPT command:
26204 accept domains = +local_domains
26208 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26209 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26210 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26211 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26214 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26215 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26216 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26219 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26220 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26221 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26222 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26223 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26224 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26226 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26227 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26229 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26230 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26231 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26233 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26234 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26235 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26240 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26241 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26242 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26243 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26244 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26245 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26246 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26250 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26251 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26252 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26255 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26257 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26261 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26262 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26263 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26264 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26265 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26266 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26267 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26268 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26269 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26271 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26272 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26273 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26277 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26278 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26279 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26281 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26282 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26284 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26285 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26288 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26289 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26290 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26291 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26293 require message = Sender did not verify
26296 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26297 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26298 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26299 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26302 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26303 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26304 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26305 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26306 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26307 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26308 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26310 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26311 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26312 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26313 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26314 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26316 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26317 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26318 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26319 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26320 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26321 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26325 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26326 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26327 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26328 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26330 warn !verify = sender
26331 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26335 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26337 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26338 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26339 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26340 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26341 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26345 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26346 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26347 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26348 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26349 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26350 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26351 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26352 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26353 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26354 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26356 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26357 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26358 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26359 on the same SMTP connection.
26361 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26362 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26363 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26366 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26367 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26368 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26370 accept hosts = whatever
26371 set acl_m4 = some value
26372 accept authenticated = *
26373 set acl_c_auth = yes
26375 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26376 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26377 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26379 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26380 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26381 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26382 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26383 error is generated.
26385 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26386 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26389 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26390 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26391 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26392 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26394 deny domains = *.dom.example
26395 !verify = recipient
26397 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26398 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26399 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26400 two statements are equivalent:
26402 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26403 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26405 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26406 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26408 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26409 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26410 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26412 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26413 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26414 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26415 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26417 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26418 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26419 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26420 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26421 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26422 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26423 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26425 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26426 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26427 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26428 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26429 message is handled.
26431 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26432 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26433 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26434 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26436 require message = Can't verify sender
26438 message = Can't verify recipient
26440 message = This message cannot be used
26442 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26443 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26444 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26445 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26446 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26447 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26449 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26450 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26451 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26452 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26455 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26456 message = Invalid sender from client host
26458 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26459 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26463 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26464 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26465 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26468 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26469 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26470 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26471 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26473 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26474 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26475 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26476 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26477 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26478 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26479 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26480 write rather ugly lines like this:
26482 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26484 Instead, all you need is
26486 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26489 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26490 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26491 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26492 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26493 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26494 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26495 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26496 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26498 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26499 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26500 in several different ways. For example:
26502 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26503 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26504 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26508 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26510 accept ...some conditions
26511 control = queue_only
26513 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26514 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26517 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26519 accept ...some conditions...
26520 control = queue_only
26521 ...some more conditions...
26523 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26524 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26525 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26529 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26530 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26533 warn ...some conditions...
26537 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26538 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26542 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26543 &%require%& verb. For example:
26545 require control = no_multiline_responses
26549 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26550 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26552 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26553 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26554 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26555 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26556 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26557 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26559 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26562 deny ...some conditions...
26565 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26566 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26569 ...some conditions...
26571 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26572 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26574 warn ...some conditions...
26580 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26581 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26582 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26583 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26584 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26585 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26586 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26590 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26591 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26592 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26593 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26594 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26595 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26596 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26599 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26600 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26601 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26602 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26604 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
26605 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26607 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26610 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26611 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26613 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26614 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26615 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26618 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26619 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26620 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26621 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26622 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26623 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26626 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26627 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26628 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26631 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26632 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26633 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26634 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26635 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26636 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26638 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26639 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26640 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26641 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26642 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26643 logging rejections.
26646 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26647 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26648 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26649 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26650 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26651 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26652 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26653 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26655 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26656 &` log_reject_target =`&
26658 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26659 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26663 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26664 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26665 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26666 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26667 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26668 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26669 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26672 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26673 &` control = freeze`&
26674 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26676 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26677 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26678 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26681 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26682 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26686 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26687 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26688 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26689 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26690 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26691 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26692 &%accept%& for details.)
26694 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26695 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26696 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26697 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26698 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26700 require message = Host not recognized
26703 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26706 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26707 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26708 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26709 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26710 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26711 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26712 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26713 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26714 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26717 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26718 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26719 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26721 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26722 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26724 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26725 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26726 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26729 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26730 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26732 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26733 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26734 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26737 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26738 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26739 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26740 However, the original message is available in the variable
26741 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26742 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26743 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26744 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26746 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26747 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26748 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26749 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26750 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26751 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26755 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26756 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26757 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26758 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26765 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26766 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26767 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26770 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26771 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26772 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26773 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26774 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26775 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26776 not work without it. For example:
26778 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26779 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26781 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26782 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26783 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26784 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26785 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26788 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26789 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26790 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26791 .cindex "case of local parts"
26792 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26793 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26794 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26795 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26796 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26797 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26800 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26801 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26802 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26803 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26804 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26806 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26807 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26810 warn control = caseful_local_part
26811 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26813 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26815 control = caselower_local_part
26817 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26818 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26821 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26822 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26823 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26824 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26825 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26826 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26827 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26828 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26829 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26833 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26834 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26835 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26839 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26840 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26841 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26842 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26843 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26844 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26845 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26846 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26848 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26849 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26850 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26851 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26852 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26853 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26857 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26858 .cindex "fake defer"
26859 .cindex "defer, fake"
26860 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26861 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26862 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26863 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26864 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26866 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26867 .cindex "fake rejection"
26868 .cindex "rejection, fake"
26869 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26870 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26871 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26872 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26873 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26874 the same SMTP connection.
26876 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26877 message is supplied, the following is used:
26879 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26880 550-kept for evaluation.
26881 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26882 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26884 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26886 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26887 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26888 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26889 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26890 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26891 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26894 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26895 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26896 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26897 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26899 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26900 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26901 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26902 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26903 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26904 disables such output flushing.
26906 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26907 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26908 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26909 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26910 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26911 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26913 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26914 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26915 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26916 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26917 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26918 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26919 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26920 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26921 to be useful in production.
26923 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26924 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26925 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26926 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26927 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26929 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26930 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26931 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26932 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26933 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26934 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26937 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26938 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26939 verification failed"&) is sent.
26941 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26945 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26946 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26948 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
26949 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
26950 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
26951 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
26952 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
26953 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
26954 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
26956 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
26957 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
26958 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
26959 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26960 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26961 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
26962 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
26963 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
26964 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
26965 same SMTP connection.
26967 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
26968 .cindex "message" "submission"
26969 .cindex "submission mode"
26970 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
26971 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
26972 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
26973 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
26974 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
26975 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
26976 late (the message has already been created).
26978 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
26979 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
26980 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
26981 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
26982 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
26984 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
26985 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
26986 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
26987 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
26988 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
26991 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
26992 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
26994 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
26996 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
26999 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27000 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27001 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27002 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27005 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27006 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27010 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27011 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27014 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27016 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27017 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27019 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27021 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27026 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27027 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27028 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27029 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27030 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27031 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27033 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27034 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27035 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27037 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27038 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27039 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27040 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27041 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27044 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
27045 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27046 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27047 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27049 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27050 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27051 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27052 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27053 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27054 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27055 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27056 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27057 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27058 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27059 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27061 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27062 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
27063 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27064 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27065 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27066 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27067 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27068 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27069 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27071 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
27072 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27074 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27075 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27077 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27078 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27080 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27081 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27082 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27083 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27086 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27087 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27088 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27089 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27090 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27091 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27092 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27095 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27096 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27097 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27098 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27099 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27101 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27102 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27103 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27104 to be a header name first.) For example:
27106 warn add_header = \
27107 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27109 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27110 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27111 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27112 up in reverse order.
27114 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27115 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27116 system filter or in a router or transport.
27121 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27122 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27123 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27124 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27125 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27126 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27128 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27129 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27130 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27131 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27132 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27133 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27134 The conditions are as follows:
27138 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27139 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27140 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27141 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27142 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27143 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27144 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27145 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27146 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27147 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27148 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27150 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27151 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27152 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27153 conditions are tested.
27155 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27156 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27157 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27158 for different local users or different local domains.
27160 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27161 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27162 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27163 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27164 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27165 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27166 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27171 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27172 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27173 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27174 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27175 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27176 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27177 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27178 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27179 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27180 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27181 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27182 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27185 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27186 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27187 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27188 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27189 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27190 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27191 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27192 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27194 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27195 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27196 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27197 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27198 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27200 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27201 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27202 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27203 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27204 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27205 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27206 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27207 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27208 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27209 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27211 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27212 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27213 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27214 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27215 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27216 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27217 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27218 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27219 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27222 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27223 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27226 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27227 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27228 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27229 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27230 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27231 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27232 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27238 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27239 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27240 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27241 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27242 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27243 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27244 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27246 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27248 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27249 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27250 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27252 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27253 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27254 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27255 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27256 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27257 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27259 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27260 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27262 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27263 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27265 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27266 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27267 statement can then check the IP address.
27269 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27270 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27271 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27272 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27274 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27275 message = $host_data
27277 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27279 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27280 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27281 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27282 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27283 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27284 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27285 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27286 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27287 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27288 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27290 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27291 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27292 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27293 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27294 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27295 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27296 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27298 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27299 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27300 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27301 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27302 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27303 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27304 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27307 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27308 .cindex "rate limiting"
27309 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27310 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27312 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27313 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27314 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27315 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27316 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27317 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27319 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27320 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27321 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27322 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27323 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27324 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27325 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27327 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27328 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27329 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27330 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27331 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27332 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27333 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27334 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27335 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27336 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27337 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27338 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27339 influence the sender checking.
27341 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27342 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27344 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27345 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27346 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27347 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27348 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27349 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27353 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27354 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27356 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27357 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27358 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27359 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27360 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27361 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27363 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27364 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27365 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27366 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27367 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27368 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27369 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27370 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27371 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27372 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27374 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27375 .cindex "CSA verification"
27376 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27377 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27378 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27380 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27381 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27382 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27383 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27384 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27385 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27386 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27387 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27388 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27389 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27390 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27391 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27392 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27393 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27394 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27396 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27397 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27398 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27399 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27402 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27403 !verify = header_sender
27406 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27407 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27408 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27409 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27410 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27411 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27412 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27413 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27414 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27415 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27416 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27417 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27420 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27421 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27425 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27426 common as they used to be.
27428 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27429 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27430 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27431 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27432 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27433 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27434 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27435 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27436 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27437 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27438 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27439 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27440 independently of this condition.
27442 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27443 option), this condition is always true.
27446 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27447 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27448 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27449 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27450 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27451 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27452 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27453 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27454 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27456 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27457 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27460 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27461 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27462 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27463 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27464 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27465 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27466 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27467 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27468 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27469 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27470 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27471 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27472 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27473 value for the child address.
27475 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27476 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27477 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27478 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27479 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27480 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27481 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27482 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27483 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27484 original IP address.
27486 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27487 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27489 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27490 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27491 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27492 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27493 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27494 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27495 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27496 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27497 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27499 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27500 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27501 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27502 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27503 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27504 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27505 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27507 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27508 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27509 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27511 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27512 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27513 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27514 verified as a sender.
27519 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27520 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27521 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27522 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27523 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27524 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27525 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27526 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27527 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27528 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27530 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27531 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27533 the following records are looked up:
27535 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27536 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27538 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27539 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27540 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27541 use two separate conditions:
27543 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27544 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27546 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27547 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27548 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27551 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27552 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27553 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27554 following special items in the list:
27556 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27557 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27558 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27560 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27561 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27562 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27563 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27565 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27567 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27568 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27570 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27571 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27572 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27574 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27575 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27576 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27577 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27581 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27582 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27583 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27584 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27585 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27587 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27589 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27590 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27591 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27592 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27597 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27598 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27599 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27600 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27601 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27602 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27603 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27605 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27606 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27608 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27609 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27610 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27611 up by this example is
27613 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27615 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27616 addresses. For example:
27618 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27619 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27621 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27622 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27627 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27628 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27629 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27630 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27631 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27632 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27633 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27634 either to double the separators like this:
27636 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27638 or to change the separator character, like this:
27640 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27642 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27643 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27644 occurs. Consider this condition:
27646 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27648 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27650 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27651 a.domain.black.list.tld
27653 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27654 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27655 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27656 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27657 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27658 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27659 error for a previous item.
27661 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27662 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27664 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27665 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27667 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27668 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27670 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27671 $sender_address_domain \
27672 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27674 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27675 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27676 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27678 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27679 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27680 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27681 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27683 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27685 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27686 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27688 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27689 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27694 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27695 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27696 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27697 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27698 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27699 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27703 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27705 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27706 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27707 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27709 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27710 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27711 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27714 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27715 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27716 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27717 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27718 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27719 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27720 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27721 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27722 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27723 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27724 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27725 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27726 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27727 cases, for example:
27729 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27731 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27732 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27733 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27734 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27736 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27738 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27739 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27741 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27742 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27743 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27744 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27745 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27748 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27749 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27750 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27752 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27753 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27755 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27760 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27761 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27762 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27763 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27766 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27768 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27769 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27770 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27771 describes how multiple records are handled.
27773 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27774 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27775 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27777 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27779 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27780 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27781 first. For example:
27783 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27784 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27787 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27788 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27789 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27790 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27791 tested. For example:
27793 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27795 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27796 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27797 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27799 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27801 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27806 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27807 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27810 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27812 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27813 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27815 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27817 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27818 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27819 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27820 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27822 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27823 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27825 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27826 previous example is precisely equivalent to
27828 deny dnslists = a.b.c
27829 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27831 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27832 Consider this example:
27834 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27836 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27839 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27841 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27843 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27844 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27845 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27847 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27852 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27853 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27854 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27855 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27856 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27857 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27859 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27861 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27862 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27863 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27864 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27865 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27866 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27869 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27870 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27871 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27873 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27874 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27877 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27879 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27880 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27882 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27884 for the condition to be true.
27887 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27888 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27890 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27891 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27893 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27895 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27896 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27898 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27899 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27901 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27903 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27904 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27906 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27908 for the condition to be false.
27910 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27911 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27916 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27917 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27918 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27919 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27920 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27921 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27922 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27923 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27924 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27927 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27928 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27929 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27930 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27931 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27932 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27933 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27936 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27937 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27939 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27940 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27942 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27943 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27944 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27945 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27946 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27947 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27949 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
27950 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
27951 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
27953 reject dnslists = \
27954 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
27955 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
27956 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
27957 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27959 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
27960 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
27961 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
27965 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
27966 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
27967 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
27968 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
27969 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
27970 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
27972 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
27973 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27975 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
27976 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
27977 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
27979 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
27981 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
27982 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
27984 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
27985 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
27987 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
27988 dnslists = some.list.example
27991 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
27992 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
27993 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
27994 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
27995 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
27996 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
27997 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
27998 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
27999 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28000 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28002 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28004 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28005 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28007 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28008 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28009 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28012 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28013 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28014 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28015 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28016 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28017 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28018 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28019 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28020 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28022 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28023 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28024 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28025 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28027 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28028 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28029 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28030 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28031 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28032 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28033 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28034 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28035 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28036 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28038 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28039 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28040 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28043 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28044 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28045 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28046 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28047 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28048 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28050 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28051 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28052 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28053 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28054 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28055 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28056 the &%count=%& option.
28059 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28060 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28061 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28062 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28063 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28065 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28066 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28067 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28068 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28070 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28071 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28072 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28073 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28074 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28075 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28076 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28078 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28079 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28080 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28081 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28082 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28083 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28084 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28086 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28087 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28088 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28089 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28092 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28093 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28094 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28095 multiple different commands.
28097 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28098 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28099 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28100 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28101 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28103 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28106 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28107 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28108 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28109 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28110 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28112 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28113 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28115 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28116 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28117 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28118 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28122 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28123 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28124 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28127 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28128 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28129 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28132 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28133 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28134 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28135 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28136 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28137 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28140 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28141 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28142 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28143 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28144 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28147 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28148 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28149 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28150 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28151 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28152 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28155 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28156 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28157 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28158 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28159 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28160 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28161 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28162 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28163 from getting any email through.
28165 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28166 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28167 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28168 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28169 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28170 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28171 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28172 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28174 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28178 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28179 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28180 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28181 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28182 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28183 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28184 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28185 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28186 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28188 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28189 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28190 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28191 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28192 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28193 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28195 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28196 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28199 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28200 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28201 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28202 required increases with larger limits.
28204 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28205 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28206 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28207 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28208 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28209 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28210 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28211 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28212 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28216 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28217 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28218 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28219 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28220 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28221 message. For example:
28223 # Log all senders' rates
28224 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28225 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28227 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28228 # at the decimal point.
28229 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28230 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28231 $sender_rate_limit }s
28233 # Keep authenticated users under control
28234 deny authenticated = *
28235 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28237 # System-wide rate limit
28238 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28239 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28241 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28242 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28243 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28244 messages per $sender_rate_period
28245 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28246 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28247 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28249 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28250 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28251 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28252 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28253 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28254 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28255 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28259 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28260 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28261 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28262 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28263 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28264 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28265 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28266 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28267 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28269 verify = sender/callout
28270 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28272 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28273 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28274 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28275 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28276 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28277 The available options are as follows:
28280 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28281 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28282 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28284 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28285 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28286 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28287 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28289 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28290 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28292 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28293 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28294 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28295 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28298 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28299 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28300 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28301 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28302 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28303 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28306 warn !verify = sender
28307 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28309 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28310 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28311 verification failure.
28313 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28314 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28317 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28318 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28320 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28322 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28323 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28324 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28326 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28328 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28331 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28332 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28337 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28338 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28339 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28340 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28341 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28342 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28343 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28344 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28345 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28346 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28347 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28348 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28351 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28352 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28353 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28354 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28355 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28356 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28358 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28359 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28360 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28361 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28362 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28364 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28365 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28366 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28367 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28368 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28369 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28370 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28371 supplies a host list.
28373 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28374 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28375 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28376 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28377 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28378 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28379 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28381 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28382 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28383 following SMTP commands are sent:
28385 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28387 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28390 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28393 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28394 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28395 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28396 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28397 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28398 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28400 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28401 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28402 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28403 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28404 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28406 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28407 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28408 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28409 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28410 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28415 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28416 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28417 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28418 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28420 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28422 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28423 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28424 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28428 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28429 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28430 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28433 verify = sender/callout=5s
28435 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28436 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28437 the &%connect%& parameter.
28440 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28441 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28442 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28443 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28445 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28447 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28449 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28450 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28451 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28452 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28453 updated in this circumstance.
28455 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28456 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28457 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28458 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28459 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28460 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28463 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28464 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28465 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28466 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28467 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28468 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28469 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28470 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28471 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28472 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28474 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28476 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28479 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28480 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28481 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28484 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28486 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28487 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28488 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28489 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28490 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28493 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28494 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28495 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28496 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28498 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28499 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28500 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28501 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28502 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28503 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28504 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28505 made, until the cache record expires.
28507 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28508 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28509 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28512 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28514 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28515 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28517 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28519 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28520 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28521 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28522 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28526 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28527 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28528 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28529 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28530 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28532 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28534 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28535 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28536 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28537 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28538 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28540 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28541 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28542 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28544 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28546 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28547 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28548 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28549 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28550 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28552 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28553 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28555 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28557 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28558 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28559 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28560 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28561 usefulness of callout caching.
28564 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28565 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28566 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28567 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28568 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28569 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28570 these circumstances.
28572 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28573 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28574 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28575 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28576 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28577 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28578 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28580 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28581 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28582 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28583 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28588 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28589 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28590 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28591 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28592 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28593 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28594 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28595 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28596 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28597 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28599 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28600 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28603 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28604 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28605 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28607 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28608 commands up to and including
28612 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28613 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28614 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28615 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28616 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28617 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28618 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28620 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28621 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28622 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28623 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28624 will eventually be noticed.
28626 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28627 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28628 behaviour will be the same.
28632 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28633 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28634 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28635 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28636 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28637 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28640 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28642 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28643 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28644 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28645 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28646 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28647 550 Sender verification failed
28649 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28650 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28651 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28652 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28655 verify = sender/no_details
28658 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28659 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28660 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28661 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28662 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28663 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28664 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28667 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28668 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28669 verification also fails.
28671 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28672 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28675 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28676 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28677 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28680 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28682 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28683 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28684 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28685 verification to succeed.
28687 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28688 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28689 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28690 option. For example:
28692 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28694 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28695 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28697 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28698 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28699 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28700 address and a report is output for each of them.
28704 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28705 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28706 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28707 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28708 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28709 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28710 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28714 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28715 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28716 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28717 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28718 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28719 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28721 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28722 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28723 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28724 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28727 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28729 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28731 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28732 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28734 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28735 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28738 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28739 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28741 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28743 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28744 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28745 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28746 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28749 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28751 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28752 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28753 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28755 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28756 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28757 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28758 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28759 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28760 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28761 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28762 of legitimate HELO domains.
28764 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28765 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28766 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28767 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28770 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28772 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28773 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28774 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28779 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28780 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28781 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28782 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28783 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28784 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28785 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28786 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28788 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28789 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28790 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28791 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28792 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28793 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28794 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28796 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28797 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28800 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28801 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28804 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28805 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28808 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28809 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28811 recipients = +batv_senders
28813 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28814 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28816 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28817 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28818 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28820 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28821 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28822 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28823 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28824 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28826 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28827 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28828 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28829 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28830 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28831 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28832 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28834 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28835 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28836 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28837 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28841 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28843 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28844 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28845 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28848 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28851 external_smtp_batv:
28853 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28854 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28855 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28856 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28859 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28863 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28864 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28865 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28866 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28867 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28868 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28869 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28870 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28871 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28872 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28874 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28875 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28876 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28877 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28878 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28879 same host is fulfilling both functions,
28881 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
28883 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28884 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28885 system to arbitrary domains.
28888 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28889 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28890 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28891 example, suppose you want to do the following:
28894 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28895 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28896 &'my.dom2.example'&.
28898 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28899 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28901 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28902 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28906 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28908 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28909 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28910 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28912 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28916 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28917 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28919 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28920 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28921 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28922 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28923 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28924 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28925 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28929 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28930 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28931 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28932 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28933 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28935 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28936 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28937 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28938 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28939 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28940 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28941 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28949 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
28950 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
28951 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
28952 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
28953 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
28954 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
28957 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
28958 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
28959 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
28960 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
28961 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
28963 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
28964 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
28965 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
28968 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
28969 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
28971 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
28972 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
28973 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
28975 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
28976 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
28978 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
28981 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
28984 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
28985 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
28986 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
28988 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
28989 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
28990 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
28991 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
28992 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
28993 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
28995 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
28996 temporarily created in a file called:
28998 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29000 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29001 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29002 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29003 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29004 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29006 control = no_mbox_unspool
29008 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29009 same directory by default.
29013 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29014 .cindex "virus scanning"
29015 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29016 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29017 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29018 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29019 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29020 in memory and thus are much faster.
29023 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29024 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29025 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29026 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29028 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29030 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29032 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29034 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29035 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29038 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29039 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29040 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29041 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29042 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29045 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29050 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29051 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29052 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29053 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29054 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29055 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29056 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29058 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29059 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29060 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29062 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29063 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29064 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29065 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29066 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29067 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29068 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29069 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29070 contributing the code for this scanner.
29073 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29074 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29075 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29076 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29079 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29080 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29083 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29084 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29085 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29086 the &"trigger"& expression.
29089 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29090 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29091 &"name"& expression.
29094 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29096 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29098 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29099 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29100 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29101 configuration setting:
29103 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29104 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29105 found in file:'(.+)'
29108 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29109 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29110 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29111 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29113 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29114 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29116 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29117 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29120 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29121 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29122 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29124 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29126 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29127 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29129 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29130 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29131 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29132 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29133 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29136 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29138 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29141 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29142 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29143 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29144 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29145 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29146 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29147 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29149 av_scanner = mksd:2
29151 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29154 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29155 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29156 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29157 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29158 client communication. For example:
29160 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29162 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29166 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29167 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29170 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29171 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29172 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29173 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29174 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29175 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29178 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29179 use. It can then be one of
29182 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29183 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29186 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29187 the condition fails immediately.
29189 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29190 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29191 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29194 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29195 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29196 causes the ACL to defer.
29198 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29199 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29200 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29201 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29204 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29205 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29206 &%malware%& condition.
29208 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29209 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29211 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29213 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29217 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29219 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29221 malware = */defer_ok
29223 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29224 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29226 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29228 in the main Exim configuration.
29230 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29231 set acl_m0 = sophie
29234 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29235 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29240 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29241 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29242 .cindex "spam scanning"
29243 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29244 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29245 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29246 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29247 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29249 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29251 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29252 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29255 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29256 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29257 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29258 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29259 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29261 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29263 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29264 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29265 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29268 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29270 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29271 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29272 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29273 option, separated with colons:
29275 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29276 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29279 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29280 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29281 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29284 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29285 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29287 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29288 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29289 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29292 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29293 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29295 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29298 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29299 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29300 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29301 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29302 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29304 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29305 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29306 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29307 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29308 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29311 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29312 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29313 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29316 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29317 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29318 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29321 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29322 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29326 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29327 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29328 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29329 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29331 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29332 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29333 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29334 available for use at delivery time.
29337 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29338 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29339 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29341 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29342 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29343 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29344 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29345 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29347 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29348 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29349 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29350 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29351 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29353 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29354 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29355 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29358 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29359 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29360 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29362 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29363 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29364 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29365 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29366 spam condition, like this:
29368 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29369 spam = joe/defer_ok
29371 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29373 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29376 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29377 warn spam = nobody:true
29378 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29379 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29381 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29382 # is over threshold
29384 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29386 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29387 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29389 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29394 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29395 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29396 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29397 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29398 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29399 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29400 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29401 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29402 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29403 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29406 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29407 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29408 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29409 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29410 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29411 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29412 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29414 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29415 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29416 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29417 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29418 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29420 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29421 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29422 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29423 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29424 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29427 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29429 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29433 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29435 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29436 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29437 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29438 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29440 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29441 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29442 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29443 the full path and file name.
29445 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29446 filename, and the default path is then used.
29448 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29449 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29450 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29452 decode = $mime_filename
29454 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29455 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29456 automatically unlinked.
29458 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29459 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29460 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29461 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29462 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29464 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29465 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29466 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29468 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29469 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29470 available in the MIME ACL:
29473 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29474 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29475 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29476 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29477 contains the empty string.
29479 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29480 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29481 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29487 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29488 case-insensitively.
29490 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29491 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29492 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29493 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29494 only used for display purposes.
29496 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29497 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29498 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29500 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29501 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29502 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29504 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29505 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29506 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29507 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29508 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29510 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29511 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29512 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29513 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29515 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29516 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29517 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29518 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29522 application/octet-stream
29526 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29529 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29530 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29531 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29532 containing the decoded data.
29537 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29538 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29539 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29540 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29541 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29542 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29544 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29545 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29546 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29547 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29549 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29550 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29554 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29557 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29558 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29561 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29562 and the rest are attachments.
29565 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29568 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29569 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29570 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29572 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29573 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29574 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29575 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29577 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29578 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29579 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29580 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29581 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29583 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29584 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29585 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29586 decoding is fully recursive.
29588 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29589 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29590 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29591 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29592 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29593 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29594 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29599 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29600 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29601 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29602 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29603 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29605 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29606 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29607 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29608 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29609 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29611 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29612 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29613 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29614 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29615 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29616 32K characters are checked.
29618 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29619 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29620 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29621 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29622 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29624 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29625 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29627 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29628 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29629 matching regular expression.
29631 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29637 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29638 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29639 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29640 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29641 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29642 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29643 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29644 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29645 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29646 use the &%demime%& condition.
29648 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29649 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29650 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29651 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29652 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29653 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29655 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29656 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29659 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29660 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29662 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29663 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29664 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29665 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29667 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29668 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29669 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29671 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29674 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29675 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29676 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29677 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29678 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29679 zero, no error occurred.
29681 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29682 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29683 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29684 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29688 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29689 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29690 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29691 extension it found.
29694 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29695 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29697 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29698 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29699 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29702 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29703 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29705 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29707 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29708 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29709 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29710 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29712 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29713 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29714 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29726 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29727 "Local scan function"
29728 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29729 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29730 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29731 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29732 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29734 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29735 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29736 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29737 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29738 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29740 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29741 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29742 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29743 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29745 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29746 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29747 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29748 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29750 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29751 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29752 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29753 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29754 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29755 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29756 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29757 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29758 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29762 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29763 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29764 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29765 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29766 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29767 directory, so you might set
29769 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29771 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29772 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29773 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29774 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29775 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29776 _src/local_scan.c_.
29778 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29779 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29781 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29783 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29788 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29789 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29790 You must include this line near the start of your code:
29792 #include "local_scan.h"
29794 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29795 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29796 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29797 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29798 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29799 strings and pointers to character strings:
29801 #define CS (char *)
29802 #define CCS (const char *)
29803 #define CSS (char **)
29804 #define US (unsigned char *)
29805 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29806 #define USS (unsigned char **)
29808 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29810 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29812 The arguments are as follows:
29815 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29816 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29817 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29819 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29820 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29821 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29822 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29823 case this changes in some future version.
29825 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29826 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29829 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29832 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29833 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29834 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29835 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29836 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29837 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29839 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29840 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29841 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29843 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29844 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29845 queued without immediate delivery.
29847 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29848 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29849 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29850 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29851 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29854 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29855 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29856 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29859 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29860 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29861 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29862 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29863 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29864 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29865 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29867 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29868 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29869 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29872 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29873 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29874 &%-oe%& command line options.
29878 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29879 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29880 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29881 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29882 want to do this, you must have the line
29884 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29886 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29887 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29888 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29891 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29892 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29893 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29894 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29895 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29896 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29898 static int my_integer_option = 42;
29899 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29901 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29902 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29903 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29906 int local_scan_options_count =
29907 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29909 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29910 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29914 my_string = some string of text...
29916 The available types of option data are as follows:
29919 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
29920 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29921 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29922 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29923 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29924 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29927 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29928 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29929 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29930 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29933 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29934 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29937 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29938 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29939 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29940 printed with the suffix K or M.
29942 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
29943 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29944 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29945 always output in octal.
29947 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29948 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
29949 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
29951 .vitem &*opt_time*&
29952 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
29953 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
29956 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
29957 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
29961 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
29962 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
29963 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
29964 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
29965 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
29966 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
29967 C variables are as follows:
29970 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
29971 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
29973 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
29974 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
29976 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
29977 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
29978 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
29979 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
29982 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
29983 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
29984 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
29987 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
29988 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
29992 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
29993 selected, you should use code like this:
29995 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29996 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29998 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
29999 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30000 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30002 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30003 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30006 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30007 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30009 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30010 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30012 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30013 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30014 &%-bh%& command line option.
30016 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30017 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30018 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30020 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30021 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30022 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30023 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30025 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30026 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30027 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30029 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30030 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30032 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30033 The number of accepted recipients.
30035 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30036 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30037 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30038 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30039 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30040 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30041 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30042 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30043 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30044 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30045 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30046 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30048 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30049 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30051 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30052 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30053 locally-submitted messages.
30055 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30056 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30057 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30059 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30060 The name of the sending host, if known.
30062 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30063 The port on the sending host.
30065 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30066 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30068 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30069 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30071 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30072 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30073 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30077 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30078 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30079 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30080 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30085 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30086 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30088 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30089 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30090 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30091 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30092 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30093 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30094 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30096 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30097 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30100 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30101 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30102 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30107 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30108 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30111 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30112 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30114 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30115 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30116 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30117 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30119 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30120 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30121 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30122 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30123 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30124 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30125 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30126 is NULL for all recipients.
30131 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30132 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30133 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30134 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30138 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30139 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30141 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30142 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30143 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30144 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30146 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30147 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30148 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30149 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30150 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30152 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30154 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30155 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30156 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30157 return value is as follows:
30162 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30168 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30174 The process timed out.
30178 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30181 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30182 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30183 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30184 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30185 forks a subprocess that is running
30187 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30189 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30190 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30191 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30192 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30194 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30195 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30196 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30197 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30200 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30201 *sender_authentication)*&
30202 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30205 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30207 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30210 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30211 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30212 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30213 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30214 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30216 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30217 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30220 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30221 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30222 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30223 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30224 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30225 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30226 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30227 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30229 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30230 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30231 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30232 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30233 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30234 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30236 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30237 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30238 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30239 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30241 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30242 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30243 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30244 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30245 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30246 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30247 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30248 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30249 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30250 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30252 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30253 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30255 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30256 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30259 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30260 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30261 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30262 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30263 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30266 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30267 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30268 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30269 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30270 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30271 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30273 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30275 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30276 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30277 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30278 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30279 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30282 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30283 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30284 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30285 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30286 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30287 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30288 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30289 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30291 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30292 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30293 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30295 &`OK `& match succeeded
30296 &`FAIL `& match failed
30297 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30299 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30300 inability to contact a database.
30302 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30304 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30305 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30306 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30308 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30310 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30311 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30312 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30314 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30316 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30319 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30321 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30322 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30323 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30324 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30325 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30326 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30329 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30331 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30332 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30333 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30334 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30335 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30336 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30339 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30340 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30341 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30342 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30344 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30345 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30346 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30347 value afterwards. For example:
30349 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30350 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30351 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30354 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30355 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30356 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30357 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30364 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30365 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30366 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30367 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30368 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30369 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30370 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30371 binary string is returned with an error message.
30373 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30374 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30375 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30377 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30378 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30379 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30380 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30381 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30383 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30384 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30385 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30387 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30388 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30389 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30390 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30394 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30395 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30398 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30399 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30400 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30401 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30402 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30403 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30404 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30405 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30408 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30409 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30411 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30412 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30413 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30414 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30415 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30416 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30417 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30419 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30420 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30422 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30423 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30424 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30425 multiple output lines.
30427 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30428 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30429 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30430 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30431 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30432 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30433 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30436 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30437 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30438 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30439 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30441 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30442 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30443 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30445 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30448 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30451 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30452 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30453 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30454 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30455 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30456 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30462 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30463 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30464 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30465 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30466 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30467 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30468 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30471 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30472 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30473 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30474 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30476 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30477 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30479 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30481 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30482 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30483 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30484 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30486 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30487 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30488 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30489 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30499 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30500 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30501 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30502 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30503 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30504 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30505 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30506 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30508 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30509 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30510 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30511 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30512 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30514 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30515 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30516 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30517 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30518 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30519 prevent it happening on retries.
30521 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30522 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30523 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30524 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30525 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30526 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30527 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30528 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30531 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30532 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30533 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30534 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30535 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30536 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30537 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30539 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30540 system_filter_user = exim
30542 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30543 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30544 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30545 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30546 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30547 by the &%reply%& command.
30550 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30551 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30552 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30553 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30555 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30556 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30560 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30561 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30562 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30563 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30564 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30565 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30568 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30569 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30570 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30571 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30572 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30573 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30574 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30576 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30577 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30578 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30579 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30580 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30582 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30583 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30584 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30585 to which users' filter files can refer.
30589 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30590 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30591 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30592 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30593 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30597 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30598 .cindex "freezing messages"
30599 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30600 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30601 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30602 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30603 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30604 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30605 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30606 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30607 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30608 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30610 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30612 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30614 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30615 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30616 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30617 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30618 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30621 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30622 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30623 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30624 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30626 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30627 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30628 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30629 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30630 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30631 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30632 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30633 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30634 message. For example:
30636 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30637 because it contains attachments that we are \
30638 not prepared to receive."
30641 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30642 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30643 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30644 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30645 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30646 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30649 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30650 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30652 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30653 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30654 generated by the filter.
30656 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30658 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30659 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30665 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30666 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30671 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30672 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30673 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30674 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30675 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30677 headers add <string>
30678 headers remove <string>
30680 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30681 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30682 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30683 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30684 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30686 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30687 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30688 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30691 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30692 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30695 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30696 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30697 space after input continuations is ignored.
30699 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30700 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30701 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30702 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30703 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30705 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30706 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30707 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30708 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30709 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30710 used for all recipients of the message.
30712 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30713 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30714 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30715 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30716 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30717 until the message is actually being written (see section
30718 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30720 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30721 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30722 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30723 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30724 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30725 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30726 modified more than once.
30728 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30729 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30732 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30733 headers remove "Subject"
30734 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30735 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30740 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30741 .cindex "envelope sender"
30742 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30744 errors_to <some address>
30746 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30747 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30748 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30751 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30753 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30754 address if its delivery failed.
30758 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30759 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30760 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30761 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30762 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30763 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30764 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30765 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30766 which implements such a filter:
30771 domains = +local_domains
30772 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30777 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30778 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30779 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30780 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30782 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30783 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30784 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30785 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30787 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
30788 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
30789 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
30796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30799 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30800 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30801 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30802 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30803 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30804 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30805 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30806 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30808 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30809 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30810 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30811 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30812 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30814 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30815 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30816 loopback interface specially in any way.
30818 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30819 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30824 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30825 .cindex "message" "submission"
30826 .cindex "submission mode"
30827 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30828 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30829 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30830 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30832 control = submission
30834 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30835 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30836 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30837 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30838 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30839 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30841 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30842 control = submission
30844 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30845 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30846 is used to separate options. For example:
30848 control = submission/sender_retain
30850 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30851 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30852 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30853 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30854 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30855 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30856 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30858 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30859 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30862 control = submission/domain=some.domain
30864 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30865 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30866 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30867 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30869 accept authenticated = *
30870 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30871 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30872 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30874 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30875 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30876 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30878 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30880 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30883 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30885 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30886 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30887 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30888 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30890 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30891 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30892 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30893 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30894 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30895 spoof another's address.
30897 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30898 .cindex "line endings"
30899 .cindex "carriage return"
30901 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30902 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30903 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30904 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30905 use CRLF or just CR.
30907 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30908 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30909 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30910 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30911 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30912 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30913 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30914 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30918 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30920 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30923 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30924 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30927 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30928 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30929 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30930 people trying to play silly games.
30932 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30933 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30941 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30942 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
30943 .cindex "address" "qualification"
30944 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30945 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30946 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30947 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30948 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
30950 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
30951 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
30952 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
30953 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
30954 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
30956 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
30957 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
30958 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
30959 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
30960 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
30961 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
30962 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
30963 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
30968 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
30969 .cindex "&""From""& line"
30970 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
30971 .cindex "sender" "address"
30972 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
30973 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
30974 .cindex "envelope sender"
30975 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30976 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
30977 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
30978 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
30980 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
30981 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
30983 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
30984 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
30985 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
30986 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
30987 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
30988 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
30989 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
30990 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
30991 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
30993 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
30994 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
30995 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
30996 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
30997 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
30998 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
30999 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31001 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31002 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31003 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31005 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31006 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31007 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31008 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31012 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31013 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31014 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31015 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31016 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31017 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31018 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31021 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31022 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31025 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31026 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31030 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31031 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31033 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31034 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31035 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31037 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31040 For a locally-submitted message,
31041 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31042 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31043 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31044 included in log lines in this case.
31046 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31047 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31053 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31054 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31055 includes the header line:
31057 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31060 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31061 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31062 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31063 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31064 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31065 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31068 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31069 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31070 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31071 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31072 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31074 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31075 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31076 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31077 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31078 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31079 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31080 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31081 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31085 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31086 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31087 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31088 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31089 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31090 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31091 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31092 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31096 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31097 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31098 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31099 .cindex "message" "submission"
31100 .cindex "submission mode"
31101 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31102 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31105 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31106 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31108 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31109 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31111 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31112 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31113 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31115 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31116 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31118 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31119 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31123 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31125 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31126 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31127 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31128 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31129 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31130 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31131 &%qualify_domain%&.
31133 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31134 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31135 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31136 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31139 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31140 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31141 .cindex "message" "submission"
31142 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31143 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31144 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31145 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31146 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31147 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31148 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31149 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31150 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31151 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31154 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31155 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31156 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31157 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31158 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31160 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31161 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31162 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31163 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31165 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31166 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31167 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31170 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31171 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31172 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31173 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31174 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31175 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31176 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31177 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31178 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31179 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31180 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31184 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31185 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31186 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31187 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31188 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31189 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31190 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31191 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31195 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31196 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31197 .cindex "message" "submission"
31198 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31199 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31200 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31201 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31204 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31205 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31206 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31207 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31208 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31209 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31210 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31211 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31212 line is added to the message.
31214 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31215 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31216 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31217 options true at the same time.
31219 .cindex "submission mode"
31220 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31221 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31222 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31223 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31225 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31226 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31227 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31228 created as follows:
31231 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31232 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31233 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31235 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31236 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31238 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31239 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31242 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31243 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31244 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31245 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31247 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31248 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31249 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31250 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31254 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31255 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31256 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31257 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31258 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31259 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31260 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31261 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31262 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31264 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31265 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31266 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31267 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31268 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31269 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31271 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31272 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31273 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31275 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31276 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31277 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31279 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31280 X-added-second: another added header line
31282 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31284 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31285 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31286 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31287 not part of the names. For example:
31289 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31291 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31292 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31293 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31294 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31295 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31297 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31298 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31299 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31300 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31302 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31303 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31304 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31307 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31308 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31309 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31310 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31311 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31312 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31313 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31315 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31316 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31317 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31318 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31320 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31321 the following consequences:
31324 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31325 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31326 to it, at all times.
31328 Header lines that are added by a router's
31329 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31330 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31332 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31333 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31335 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31336 a later router or by a transport.
31338 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31339 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31341 headers_remove = subject
31342 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31346 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31347 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31353 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31354 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31355 .cindex "constructed address"
31356 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31359 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31363 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31365 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31366 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31367 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31368 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31369 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31370 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31371 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31372 there is no password file entry.
31375 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31376 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31377 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31378 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31379 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31380 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31381 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31382 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31386 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31387 .cindex "case of local parts"
31388 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31389 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31390 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31391 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31392 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31393 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31394 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31397 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31398 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31399 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31400 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31401 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31405 domains = +local_domains
31406 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31407 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31410 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31411 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31412 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31413 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31414 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31418 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31419 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31420 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31421 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31422 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31423 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31424 empty components for compatibility.
31428 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31429 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31430 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31431 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31432 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31433 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31435 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31436 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31437 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31438 example, a header such as
31442 might get rewritten as
31444 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31446 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31447 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31450 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31451 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31452 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31453 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31454 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31455 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31456 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31463 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31464 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31465 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31466 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31467 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31468 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31469 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31472 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31474 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31476 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31479 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31482 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31484 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31487 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31490 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31491 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31494 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31495 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31496 used to contain the envelope information.
31500 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31501 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31502 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31503 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31504 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31507 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31508 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31509 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31510 processing is the same in both cases.
31512 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31513 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31514 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31515 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31516 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31517 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31518 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31519 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31522 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31523 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31524 required for the transaction.
31526 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31527 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31528 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31530 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31531 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31532 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31534 .cindex "carriage return"
31536 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31537 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31538 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31541 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31542 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31543 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31544 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31545 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31546 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31547 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31548 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31549 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31551 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31552 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31553 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31554 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31556 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31557 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31558 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31559 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31561 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31562 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31563 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31564 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31565 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31566 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31567 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31568 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31569 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31570 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31572 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31573 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31575 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31576 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31577 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31578 square bracket of the IP address.
31583 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31584 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31585 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31586 .cindex "host" "error"
31587 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31588 message errors, and recipient errors.
31591 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31592 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31593 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31596 Connection refused or timed out,
31598 Any error response code on connection,
31600 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31602 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31604 I/O errors at any time,
31606 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31607 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31610 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31611 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31612 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31613 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31614 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31615 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31616 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31617 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31619 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31620 .cindex "message" "error"
31621 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31622 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31623 message errors are:
31626 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31629 Timeout after MAIL,
31631 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31632 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31633 connection at any other time.
31636 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31637 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31638 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31639 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31640 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31641 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31642 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31643 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31644 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31645 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31647 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31648 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31649 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31652 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31653 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31654 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31655 recipient errors are:
31658 Any error response to RCPT,
31660 Timeout after RCPT.
31663 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31664 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31665 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31666 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31667 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31668 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31669 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31670 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31671 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31672 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31673 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31674 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31675 the retry clock is reset.
31677 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31678 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31679 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31680 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31681 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31682 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31683 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31684 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31685 recipient's retry time.
31688 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31689 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31690 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31691 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31692 until the next delivery attempt.
31694 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31695 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31696 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31697 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31698 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31701 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31702 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31703 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31704 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31705 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31706 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31707 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31709 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31710 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31711 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31712 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31713 then to be treated as a host error.
31715 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31716 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31717 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31718 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31719 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31724 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31725 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31726 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31729 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31730 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31731 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31733 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31735 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31736 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31737 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31738 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31739 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31740 stream and exits with an error code.
31742 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31743 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31744 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31745 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31747 .cindex "carriage return"
31749 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31750 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31751 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31753 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31754 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31755 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31757 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31758 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31759 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31760 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31761 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31762 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31763 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31764 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31766 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31767 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31768 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31769 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31770 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31771 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31772 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31773 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31774 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31776 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31777 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31778 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31780 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31781 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31782 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31783 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31784 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31786 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31787 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31788 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31789 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31790 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31791 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31792 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31794 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31795 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31796 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31797 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31798 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31800 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31801 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31802 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31803 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31804 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31805 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31806 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31807 a delivery process.
31809 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31810 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31811 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31812 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31813 however, available with &'inetd'&.
31815 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31816 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31817 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31818 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31820 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31821 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31822 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31826 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31827 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31828 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31829 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31830 the error response to the last command. The default value for
31831 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31832 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31833 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31836 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31837 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31838 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31839 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31840 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31841 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31842 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31843 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31844 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31845 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31846 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31850 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31851 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31852 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31853 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31854 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31855 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31856 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31857 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31859 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31860 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31861 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31862 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31863 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31866 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31867 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31868 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31870 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31871 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31872 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31873 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31874 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31879 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31880 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31881 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31882 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31883 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31885 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31886 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31887 called with the &%-bv%& option.
31889 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31890 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31891 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31892 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31893 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31894 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31895 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31900 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31901 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31902 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31903 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31904 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31905 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31906 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31908 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31909 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31910 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31911 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31912 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31913 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31914 argument. For example,
31922 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31923 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31924 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31925 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31926 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31928 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31929 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31930 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31931 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31932 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31933 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31934 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31935 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31937 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31938 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31939 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31940 whatever the form of its argument. For
31943 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31944 $sender_host_address
31946 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31947 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31948 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
31949 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
31950 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
31951 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
31952 for it to change them before running the command.
31956 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
31957 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
31958 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
31959 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
31960 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
31961 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
31962 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
31963 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
31964 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
31965 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
31966 runs for RCPT commands:
31970 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
31974 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
31975 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
31976 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
31977 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
31978 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
31979 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
31980 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
31981 envelope along with the message.
31983 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
31984 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
31985 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
31986 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
31987 can be used to specify it.
31989 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
31990 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
31991 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
31992 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
31993 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
31996 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
31997 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
31998 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32003 driver = manualroute
32004 transport = smtp_appendfile
32005 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32009 driver = appendfile
32010 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32015 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32016 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32017 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32021 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32022 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32023 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32024 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32025 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32026 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32027 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32028 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32029 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32030 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32032 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32033 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32035 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32036 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32037 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32038 make some use of automatically, for example:
32040 554 Unexpected end of file
32041 Transaction started in line 10
32042 Error detected in line 14
32044 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32047 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32048 The error message was:
32050 501 '>' missing at end of address
32052 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32053 The error was detected in line 12.
32054 The SMTP command at fault was:
32056 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32058 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32059 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32061 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32062 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32064 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32065 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32072 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32073 "Customizing messages"
32074 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32075 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32076 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32077 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32078 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32080 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32081 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32082 option. Exim also adds the line
32084 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32086 to all warning and bounce messages,
32089 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32090 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32091 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32092 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32093 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32094 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32095 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32097 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32098 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32099 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32100 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32101 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32104 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32105 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32106 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32107 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32108 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32109 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32110 option, rounded to a whole number.
32112 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32115 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32116 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32118 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32119 failing addresses with their error messages.
32121 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32122 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32124 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32125 as part of the error report.
32127 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32128 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32130 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32133 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32134 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32135 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32137 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32138 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32139 {: returning message to sender}}
32141 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32143 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32144 {that you sent }{sent by
32148 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32149 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32151 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32153 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32156 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32158 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32161 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32162 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32163 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32164 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32165 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32169 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32170 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32172 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32173 the delayed addresses.
32175 The third item then ends the message.
32178 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32179 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32181 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32182 $warn_message_delay
32184 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32186 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32187 {that you sent }{sent by
32191 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32192 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32194 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32195 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32196 The date of the message is: $h_date
32198 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32200 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32201 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32202 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32203 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32204 the message will be returned to you.
32206 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32207 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32208 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32209 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32210 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32211 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32212 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32213 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32222 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32223 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32224 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32228 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32229 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32230 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32231 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32232 routing explicitly:
32234 send_to_smart_host:
32235 driver = manualroute
32236 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32237 transport = remote_smtp
32239 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32240 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32241 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32242 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32243 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32248 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32249 .cindex "mailing lists"
32250 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32251 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32252 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32254 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32255 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32256 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32257 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32261 domains = lists.example
32262 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32265 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32268 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32269 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32270 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32271 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32273 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32274 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32277 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32278 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32279 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32280 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32281 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32283 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32284 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32285 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32286 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32287 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32288 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32289 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32290 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32291 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32295 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32296 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32297 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32298 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32299 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32300 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32301 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32303 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32304 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32305 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32306 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32307 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32311 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32312 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32313 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32314 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32315 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32316 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32317 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32318 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32319 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32320 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32322 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32323 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32324 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32325 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32326 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32327 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32328 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32329 pre-existing messages.
32331 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32332 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32333 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32334 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32335 one level of expansion anyway.
32339 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32340 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32341 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32342 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32343 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32344 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32346 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32347 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32351 domains = lists.example
32352 local_part_suffix = -request
32353 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32358 domains = lists.example
32359 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32360 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32361 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32364 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32369 domains = lists.example
32371 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32373 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32374 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32375 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32378 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32379 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32380 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32381 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32382 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32383 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32384 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32385 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32386 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32388 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32389 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32390 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32395 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32397 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32398 .cindex "envelope sender"
32399 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32400 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32401 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32402 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32403 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32404 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32406 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32407 .oindex &%return_path%&
32408 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32409 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32410 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32411 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32412 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32413 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32414 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32420 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32421 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32423 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32424 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32425 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32426 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32427 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32428 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32429 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32432 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32434 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32435 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32436 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32437 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32438 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32439 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32441 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32442 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32443 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32444 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32448 domains = ! +local_domains
32450 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32451 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32454 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32455 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32456 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32457 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32460 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32461 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32462 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32463 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32464 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32468 domains = ! +local_domains
32469 transport = remote_smtp
32471 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32472 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32475 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32476 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32477 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32478 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32481 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32482 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32483 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32484 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32485 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32486 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32494 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32495 .cindex "virtual domains"
32496 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32497 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32501 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32502 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32503 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32505 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32506 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32507 have login accounts on that host.
32510 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32511 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32512 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32513 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32514 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32515 to a router of this form:
32519 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32520 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32523 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32524 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32525 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32526 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32527 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32528 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32530 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32531 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32532 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32533 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32535 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32536 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32537 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32541 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32542 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32543 transport = my_mailboxes
32545 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32546 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32547 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32548 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32549 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32553 driver = appendfile
32554 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32557 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32558 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32560 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32561 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32562 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32563 information about the domains.
32567 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32568 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32569 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32570 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32571 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32572 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32573 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32574 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32575 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32576 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32577 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32578 example, consider this router:
32583 file = $home/.forward
32584 local_part_suffix = -*
32585 local_part_suffix_optional
32588 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32589 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32590 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32591 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32593 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32594 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32597 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32598 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32599 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32600 control over which suffixes are valid.
32602 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32603 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32609 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32610 local_part_suffix = -*
32611 local_part_suffix_optional
32614 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32615 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32616 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32617 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32618 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32622 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32623 .cindex "vacation processing"
32624 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32625 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32626 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32627 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32628 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32631 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32632 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32633 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32634 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32636 spqr, vacation-spqr
32639 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32640 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32641 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32642 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32643 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32647 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32648 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32652 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32653 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32654 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32655 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32656 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32657 each day's messages.
32659 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32660 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32661 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32662 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32666 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32667 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32668 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32669 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32670 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32671 permanently connected.
32673 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32674 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32675 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32678 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32679 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32680 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32681 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32682 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32683 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32684 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32685 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32687 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32688 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32689 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32690 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32691 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32692 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32695 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32696 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32697 intermittent host. For example:
32699 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32701 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32702 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32703 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32704 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32705 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32706 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32709 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32710 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32711 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32712 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32713 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32714 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32715 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32719 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32720 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32721 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32722 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32723 delivered immediately.
32725 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32726 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32727 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32728 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32729 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32730 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32731 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32732 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32733 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32734 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32735 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32736 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32737 single SMTP connection.
32741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32744 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32745 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32746 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32747 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32748 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32749 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32750 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32751 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32752 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32753 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32756 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32757 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32758 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32759 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32760 email is not desirable.
32762 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32763 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32764 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32765 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32766 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32767 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32768 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32770 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32771 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32772 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32773 before sending a message to the smart host.
32775 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32776 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32777 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32779 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32780 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32781 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32782 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32783 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32784 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32785 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32787 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32791 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32792 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32794 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32795 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32796 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32797 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32798 successful, a zero return code is given.
32800 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32801 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32802 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32803 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32804 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32807 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32808 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32809 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32811 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32812 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32813 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32814 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32815 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32817 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32818 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32819 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32821 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32822 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32823 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32824 are ever generated.
32826 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32828 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32829 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32830 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32833 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32834 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32835 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32836 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32837 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32838 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32846 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32847 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32848 .cindex "log" "types of"
32849 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32854 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32855 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32856 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32857 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32858 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32859 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32860 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32861 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32863 .cindex "reject log"
32864 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32865 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32866 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32867 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32868 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32869 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32870 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32871 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32872 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32875 .cindex "panic log"
32876 .cindex "system log"
32877 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32878 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32879 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32880 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32881 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32882 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32883 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32884 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32885 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32888 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32889 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32890 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32892 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32895 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32896 ways of changing this:
32899 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32904 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32906 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32909 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32913 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32914 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32915 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32916 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32917 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32918 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32923 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32924 .cindex "log" "destination"
32925 .cindex "log" "to file"
32926 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
32928 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32929 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32930 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32931 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32932 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32933 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32934 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32936 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32937 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32938 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32939 references to the host name:
32941 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32943 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32944 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32945 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32946 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32947 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32950 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
32951 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
32952 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
32953 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
32954 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
32955 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
32956 implying the use of a default path.
32958 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
32959 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
32960 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
32961 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
32962 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
32963 equivalent to the setting:
32965 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
32967 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
32970 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
32971 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
32973 Here are some examples of possible settings:
32975 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
32976 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
32977 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
32978 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
32980 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
32985 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
32986 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32987 .cindex "cycling logs"
32988 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32989 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
32990 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
32991 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
32992 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
32993 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
32994 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
32996 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
32997 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
32998 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
32999 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33000 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33001 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33002 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33003 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33004 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33005 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33006 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33011 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33012 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33013 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33014 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33015 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33016 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33017 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33018 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33020 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33021 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33022 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33023 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33025 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33026 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33028 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33029 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33030 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33031 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33033 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33034 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33035 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33036 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33038 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33039 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33040 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33041 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33042 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33043 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33046 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33047 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33048 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33049 /var/log/exim/panic
33053 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33054 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33055 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33056 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33057 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33058 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33059 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33060 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33061 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33062 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33063 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33064 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33065 the time and host name to each line.
33066 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33069 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33071 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33073 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33076 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33077 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33078 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33079 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33081 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33082 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33083 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33084 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33085 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33086 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33087 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33088 RFC 3164, you should set
33090 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33092 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33093 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33095 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33096 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33097 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33098 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33099 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33100 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33101 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33102 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33103 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33105 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33106 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33107 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33108 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33111 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33114 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33115 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33116 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33117 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33119 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33120 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33121 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33122 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33123 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33124 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33126 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33127 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33128 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33131 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33133 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33134 without modification.
33136 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33137 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33138 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33143 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33144 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33145 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33146 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33147 timestamp. The flags are:
33149 &`<=`& message arrival
33150 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33151 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33152 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33153 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33154 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33158 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33159 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33160 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33161 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33162 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33164 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33165 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33166 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33168 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33169 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33170 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33174 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33178 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33179 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33180 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33181 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33182 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33183 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33184 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33185 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33186 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33187 name in parentheses.
33189 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33190 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33191 the log containing text like these examples:
33193 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33194 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33196 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33199 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33200 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33203 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33204 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33205 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33206 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33207 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33208 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33209 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33210 suite that was used.
33212 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33213 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33214 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33215 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33216 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33217 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33218 authenticator name.
33220 .cindex "size" "of message"
33221 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33222 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33223 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33224 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33227 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33228 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33232 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33233 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33234 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33235 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33236 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33237 to fit it on the page:
33239 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33240 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33241 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33242 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33243 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33245 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33246 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33247 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33248 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33249 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33251 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33252 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33254 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33256 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33257 parentheses afterwards.
33259 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33260 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33261 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33262 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33263 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33264 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33266 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33267 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33269 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33270 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33273 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33274 .cindex "discarded messages"
33275 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33276 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33277 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33278 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33280 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33281 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33283 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33284 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33286 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33287 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33291 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33292 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33294 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33295 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33297 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33298 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33299 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33301 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33302 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33304 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33305 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33306 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33310 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33311 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33312 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33313 following form is logged:
33315 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33316 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33318 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33319 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33321 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33322 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33323 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33324 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33325 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33327 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33328 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33329 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33330 flagged with &`**`&.
33334 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33335 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33336 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33337 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33338 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33342 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33345 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33347 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33348 at the end of its processing.
33353 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33354 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33355 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33356 the following table:
33358 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33359 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33360 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33361 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33362 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33363 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33364 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33365 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33366 &`H `& host name and IP address
33367 &`I `& local interface used
33368 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33369 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33370 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33371 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33372 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33373 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33374 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33375 &`S `& size of message
33376 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33377 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33378 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33379 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33380 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33384 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33385 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33386 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33389 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33390 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33391 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33392 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33393 during the first delivery attempt.
33395 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33396 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33397 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33399 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33400 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33401 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33402 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33403 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33406 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33407 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33410 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33411 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33413 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33414 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33416 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33417 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33418 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33422 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33430 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33431 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33432 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33433 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33434 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33437 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33439 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33440 selection marked by asterisks:
33442 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33443 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33444 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33445 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33446 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33447 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33448 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33449 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33450 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33451 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33452 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33453 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33454 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33455 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33456 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33457 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33458 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33459 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33460 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33461 &` pid `& Exim process id
33462 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33463 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33464 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33465 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33466 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33467 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33468 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33469 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33470 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33471 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33472 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33473 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33474 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33475 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33476 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33477 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33478 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33479 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33480 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33481 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33482 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33484 &` all `& all of the above
33486 More details on each of these items follows:
33489 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33490 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33491 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33492 this log selector is set.
33494 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33495 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33496 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33497 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33498 such users cannot access the log).
33500 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33501 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33502 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33503 parentheses between them.
33505 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33506 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33507 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33508 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33509 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33510 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33511 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33512 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33513 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33514 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33515 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33516 between the caller and Exim.
33518 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33519 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33520 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33522 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33523 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33524 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33525 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33526 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33527 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33529 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33530 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33531 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33533 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33534 .cindex "size" "of message"
33535 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33536 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33538 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33539 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33540 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33541 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33542 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33544 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33545 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33546 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33547 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33548 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33549 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33551 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33552 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33553 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33554 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33555 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33557 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33558 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33559 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33560 client's ident port times out.
33562 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33563 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33564 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33565 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33566 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33567 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33570 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33571 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33572 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33573 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33574 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33575 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33576 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33577 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33578 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33579 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33580 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33582 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33583 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33584 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33586 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33587 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33588 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33589 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33590 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33591 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33592 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33594 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33595 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33596 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33597 immediately after the time and date.
33599 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33600 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33601 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33603 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33604 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33605 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33606 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33607 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33608 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33609 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33610 message has been successfully received.
33612 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33613 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33614 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33615 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33617 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33618 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33619 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33620 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33621 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33623 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33626 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33627 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33628 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33629 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33631 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33632 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33633 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33634 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33635 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33637 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33638 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33639 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33640 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33643 .cindex "log" "return path"
33644 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33645 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33646 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33647 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33649 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33650 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33651 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33652 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33653 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33655 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33656 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33657 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33658 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33661 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33662 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33665 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33666 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33667 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33668 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33670 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33671 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33673 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33674 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33675 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33676 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33677 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33680 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33681 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33682 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33683 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33684 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33685 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33686 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33687 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33688 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33689 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33691 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33692 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33693 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33694 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33695 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33696 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33697 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33698 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33700 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33701 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33702 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33703 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33704 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33705 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33707 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33708 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33709 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33710 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33711 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33712 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33713 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33714 already have their own log lines.
33716 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33717 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33718 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33719 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33720 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33721 the same logging options.
33723 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33724 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33728 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33729 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33730 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33731 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33732 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33734 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33735 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33736 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33737 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33738 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33739 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33740 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33741 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33743 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33744 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33745 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33746 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33747 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33748 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33749 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33750 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33751 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33753 .cindex "log" "subject"
33754 .cindex "subject, logging"
33755 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33756 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33757 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33758 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33759 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33761 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33762 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33763 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33764 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33766 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33767 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33768 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33769 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33771 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33772 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33773 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33774 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33775 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33777 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
33778 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
33779 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
33780 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
33781 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
33783 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33784 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33785 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33789 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
33790 .cindex "message" "log file for"
33791 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33792 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33793 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33794 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33795 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33796 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33797 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33798 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33799 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33800 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33801 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33803 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33804 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33805 &%message_logs%& option false.
33811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33814 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33815 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33816 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33817 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33818 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33820 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33821 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33822 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33823 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33824 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33825 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33826 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33828 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33829 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33830 "extract statistics from the log"
33831 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33832 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33833 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33834 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33835 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33836 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33837 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33838 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33841 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33842 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33843 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33848 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33849 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33850 .cindex "process, querying"
33852 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33853 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33854 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33855 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33856 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33857 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33858 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33859 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33861 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33862 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33863 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33866 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33867 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33868 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33869 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33870 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33873 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33874 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33875 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33876 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33878 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33880 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
33881 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
33882 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33883 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
33884 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
33885 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33887 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33888 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33892 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33893 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33894 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
33895 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33899 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33900 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33901 options are available:
33904 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33905 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33906 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33910 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33911 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33914 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33915 Match against the size field.
33917 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33918 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33920 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33921 Match messages that are older than the given time.
33924 Match only frozen messages.
33927 Match only non-frozen messages.
33930 The following options control the format of the output:
33934 Display only the count of matching messages.
33937 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33941 Display message ids only.
33944 Brief format &-- one line per message.
33947 Display messages in reverse order.
33950 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
33954 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
33955 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
33956 .cindex "queue" "summary"
33957 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
33958 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
33959 running a command such as
33961 exim -bp | exiqsumm
33963 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
33964 it, as in the following example:
33966 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
33968 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
33969 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
33970 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
33971 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
33973 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
33974 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
33975 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
33976 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
33977 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
33978 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
33981 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
33982 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
33983 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
33984 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
33985 level"& addresses).
33990 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
33992 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
33993 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
33994 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
33995 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
33996 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
33997 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
33998 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
33999 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34000 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34001 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34003 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34005 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34007 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34008 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34009 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34011 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34012 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34013 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34014 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34015 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34017 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34018 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34019 regular expression.
34021 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34022 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34024 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34025 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34026 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34029 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34030 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34031 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34032 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34033 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34034 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34035 the &%--help%& option.
34038 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34039 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34040 .cindex "cycling logs"
34041 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34042 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34043 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34044 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34045 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34046 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34047 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34049 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34050 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34052 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34053 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34054 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34058 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34059 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34060 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34061 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34062 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34063 logs are handled similarly.
34065 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34066 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34067 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34068 any existing log files.
34070 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34071 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34072 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34073 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34074 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34076 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34078 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34079 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34083 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34084 .cindex "statistics"
34085 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34086 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34087 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34088 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34089 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34091 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34092 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34093 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34094 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34095 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34097 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34099 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34100 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34101 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34102 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34103 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34104 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34105 also produced per user.
34107 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34108 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34109 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34110 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34111 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34113 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34114 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34115 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34116 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34117 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34118 an entirely separate message.
34120 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34121 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34122 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34123 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34124 least one address that failed.
34126 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34127 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34128 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34129 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34130 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34131 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34132 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34134 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34135 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34136 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34138 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34139 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34140 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34142 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34145 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34146 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34147 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34148 .cindex "checking access"
34149 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34150 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34151 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34152 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34153 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34154 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34156 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34157 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34159 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34161 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34162 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34163 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34164 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34167 550 Relay not permitted
34169 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34170 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34171 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34172 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34175 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34176 -f himself@there.example
34178 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34179 mandatory arguments.
34181 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34182 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34183 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34187 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34188 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34189 .cindex "building DBM files"
34190 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34191 .cindex "lower casing"
34192 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34193 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34194 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34195 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34196 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34197 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34199 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34200 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34201 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34202 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34205 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34206 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34207 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34211 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34212 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34213 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34214 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34216 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34218 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34219 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34221 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34222 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34223 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34224 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34225 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34226 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34228 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34229 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34230 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34231 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34232 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34233 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34234 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34240 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34241 .cindex "retry" "times"
34242 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34243 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34244 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34245 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34246 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34247 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34248 output. For example:
34250 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34251 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34252 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34253 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34254 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34255 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34256 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34257 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34258 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34259 past final cutoff time
34261 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34262 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34263 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34264 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34265 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34266 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34269 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34270 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34271 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34272 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34273 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34274 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34278 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34279 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34280 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34281 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34282 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34283 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34284 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34287 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34289 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34292 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34294 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34296 &'misc'&: other hints data
34299 The &'misc'& database is used for
34302 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34304 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34305 &(smtp)& transport)
34310 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34311 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34312 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34313 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34314 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34316 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34318 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34320 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34321 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34323 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34324 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34325 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34326 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34327 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34328 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34329 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34330 and a textual description of the error.
34332 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34333 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34334 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34337 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34338 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34339 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34340 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34341 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34342 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34347 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34348 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34349 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34350 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34351 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34352 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34353 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34354 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34355 updated sufficiently often.
34357 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34358 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34359 the retry database:
34361 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34363 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34364 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34365 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34366 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34367 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34368 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34369 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34370 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34371 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34372 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34373 whenever it removes information from the database.
34375 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34376 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34377 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34378 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34379 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34381 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34382 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34383 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34384 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34385 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34386 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34387 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34390 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34391 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34396 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34397 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34398 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34399 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34400 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34401 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34402 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34405 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34406 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34407 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34408 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34409 by new data, for example:
34413 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34414 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34415 used as optional separators.
34420 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34421 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34422 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34423 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34424 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34425 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34426 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34427 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34428 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34429 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34430 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34431 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34432 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34436 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34439 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34442 .vitem &%-interval%&
34443 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34444 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34446 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34447 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34450 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34453 Suppress verification output.
34455 .vitem &%-retries%&
34456 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34457 the lock (default 10).
34459 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34460 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34461 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34462 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34465 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34466 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34467 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34468 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34471 Generate verbose output.
34474 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34475 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34476 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34477 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34478 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34479 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34480 more than 30 minutes old.
34482 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34483 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34484 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34485 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34486 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34487 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34489 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34490 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34491 suppresses all output except error messages.
34495 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34497 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34499 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34500 <&'some commands'&>
34503 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34504 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34507 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34508 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34510 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34511 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34518 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34519 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34520 .cindex "X-windows"
34521 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34522 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34523 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34524 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34525 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34526 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34527 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34528 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34532 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34533 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34534 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34535 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34536 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34537 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34538 parameters are for.
34540 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34541 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34542 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34544 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34546 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34547 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34548 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34549 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34550 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34552 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34553 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34555 Eximon*background: gray94
34557 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34558 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34559 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34560 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34561 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34562 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34563 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34566 Eximon*highlight: gray
34569 .cindex "admin user"
34570 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34571 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34573 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34574 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34575 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34576 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34577 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34579 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34580 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34581 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34582 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34583 different parts of the display.
34588 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34589 .cindex "stripchart"
34590 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34591 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34592 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34593 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34594 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34595 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34596 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34597 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34598 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34600 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34601 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34602 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34603 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34605 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34606 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34607 to a single partition.
34609 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34610 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34611 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34612 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34613 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34614 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34615 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34620 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34621 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34622 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34623 .cindex "window size"
34624 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34625 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34626 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34627 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34628 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34629 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34631 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34632 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34633 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34634 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34636 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34637 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34638 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34639 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34640 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34641 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34643 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34644 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34645 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34649 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34650 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34651 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34652 the main log is maintained.
34653 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34654 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34655 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34656 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34657 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34659 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34660 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34661 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34662 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34663 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34664 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34665 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34666 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34667 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34668 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34669 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34671 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34672 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34673 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34674 It cannot go further back up the log.
34676 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34677 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34678 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34679 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34680 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34681 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34683 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34684 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34685 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34686 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34687 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34688 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34690 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34691 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34692 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34693 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34694 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34695 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34696 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34697 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34698 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34703 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34704 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34705 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34706 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34707 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34708 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34709 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34710 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34711 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34712 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34714 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34715 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34716 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34717 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34718 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34719 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34720 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34722 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34723 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34724 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34725 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34726 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34727 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34728 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34730 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34731 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34732 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34733 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34735 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34736 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34737 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34738 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34739 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34740 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34741 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34744 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34745 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34747 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34748 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34749 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34750 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34751 display is updated.
34755 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34756 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34757 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34758 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34759 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34762 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34763 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34764 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34765 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34766 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34768 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34770 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34774 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34775 in a new text window.
34777 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34778 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34779 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34781 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34782 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34783 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34784 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34786 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34787 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34788 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34789 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34790 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34792 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34793 that the message be frozen.
34795 .cindex "thawing messages"
34796 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
34797 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34798 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34799 that the message be thawed.
34801 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34802 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34803 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34804 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34806 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34807 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34810 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34811 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34812 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34813 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34814 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34815 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34816 which case no action is taken.
34818 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34819 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34820 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34821 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34822 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34823 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34824 case no action is taken.
34826 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34827 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34829 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34830 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34831 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34832 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34833 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34834 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34835 the address is qualified with that domain.
34838 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34839 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34840 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34841 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34842 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34843 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34844 if no output is generated.
34846 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34847 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34848 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34849 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34851 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34852 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34853 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34863 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34864 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34865 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34866 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34868 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34869 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34870 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34871 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34872 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34873 its security as compared with other MTAs.
34875 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34876 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34877 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34878 as soon as possible.
34881 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34882 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
34883 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34884 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34885 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34886 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34889 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34890 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34891 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34892 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34893 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34894 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34896 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34897 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34898 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34899 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34902 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34903 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34904 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34905 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34906 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34907 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34908 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34909 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34910 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34914 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34915 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34916 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34917 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34918 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34919 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34920 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34922 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34925 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34926 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34927 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34928 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34929 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34934 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34936 .cindex "root privilege"
34937 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34938 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34939 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34940 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34941 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34942 is required for two things:
34945 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34946 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34949 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
34950 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
34954 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
34955 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
34956 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
34957 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
34958 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
34959 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
34960 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
34961 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
34963 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
34964 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
34965 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
34967 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
34968 uid and gid in the following cases:
34973 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
34974 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
34975 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
34976 the calling process.
34977 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
34978 option may not be used at all.
34979 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
34980 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
34981 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
34986 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
34987 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
34990 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
34991 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
34992 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
34993 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
34994 testing address verification
34997 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35000 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35001 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35004 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35007 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35008 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35009 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35010 will be used during message reception.
35012 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35013 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35015 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35016 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35017 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35018 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35019 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35020 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35021 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35022 generating bounce and warning messages.
35024 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35025 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35026 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35027 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35029 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35030 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35036 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35037 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35038 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35039 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35040 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35041 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35042 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35043 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35044 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35045 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35049 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35050 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35051 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35052 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35054 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35055 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35056 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35057 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35058 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35060 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35061 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35062 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35065 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35066 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35067 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35069 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35070 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35071 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35072 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35073 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35074 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35075 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35076 address this problem at this time.
35078 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35079 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35080 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35081 be used in the most straightforward way.
35083 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35084 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35087 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35088 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35089 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35090 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35091 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35093 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35094 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35096 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35097 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35098 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35099 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35101 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35102 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35105 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35106 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35107 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35109 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35110 owned by the Exim user.
35112 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35113 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35114 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35119 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35120 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35121 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35122 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35124 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35125 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35130 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35131 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35132 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35136 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35137 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35138 .cindex "IP source routing"
35139 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35140 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35141 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35142 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35146 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35147 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35148 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35153 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35154 .cindex "trusted users"
35155 .cindex "admin user"
35156 .cindex "privileged user"
35157 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35158 .cindex "user" "admin"
35159 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35160 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35161 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35162 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35163 permit a remote host to be specified.
35166 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35167 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35168 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35169 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35170 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35171 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35173 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35174 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35175 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35176 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35177 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35179 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35180 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35181 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35182 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35183 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35187 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35188 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35189 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35190 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35191 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35192 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35194 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35195 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35196 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35197 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35198 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35199 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35204 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35205 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35206 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35207 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35208 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35209 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35213 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35214 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35215 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35216 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35217 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35222 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35223 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35224 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35225 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35230 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35231 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35232 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35233 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35234 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35238 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35239 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35240 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35244 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35245 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35246 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35247 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35248 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35249 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35250 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35252 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35253 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35258 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35259 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35260 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35261 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35265 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35266 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35267 enough to hold the result.
35268 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35274 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35276 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35277 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35278 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35279 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35280 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35281 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35282 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35283 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35284 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35285 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35286 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35287 themselves are recoverable.
35289 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35290 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35291 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35294 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35295 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35296 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35297 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35298 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35300 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35301 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35302 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35303 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35304 will always be the case.
35306 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35308 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35311 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35313 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35314 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35315 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35316 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35317 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35318 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35319 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35320 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35323 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35324 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35325 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35326 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35327 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35328 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35329 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35330 normally the Exim user.
35332 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35333 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35334 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35335 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35336 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35337 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35338 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35339 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35341 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35342 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35343 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35344 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35346 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35347 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35350 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35351 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35352 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35353 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35354 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35355 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35356 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35357 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35358 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35361 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35362 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35363 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35364 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35365 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35366 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35368 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35369 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35370 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35371 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35372 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35373 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35375 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35376 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35377 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35379 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35380 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35381 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35382 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35383 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35385 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35386 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35387 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35388 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35389 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35391 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35392 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35393 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35395 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35396 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35397 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35399 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35400 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35403 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35404 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35405 present if the number is greater than zero.
35407 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35408 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35409 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35411 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35412 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35413 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35415 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35416 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35419 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35420 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35421 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35424 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35425 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35426 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35427 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35429 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35430 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35431 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35433 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35434 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35435 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35436 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35437 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35438 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35440 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35441 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35442 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35443 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35444 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35446 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35447 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35448 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35449 generated messages.
35452 The message is from a local sender.
35454 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35455 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35457 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35458 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35459 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35460 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35462 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35463 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35464 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35467 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35468 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35471 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35472 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35473 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35475 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35476 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35477 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35479 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35480 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35481 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35483 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35484 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35485 certificate was verified by the server.
35487 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35488 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35489 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35491 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35492 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35493 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35497 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35498 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35499 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35500 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35501 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35502 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35503 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35504 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35505 addresses are complete.
35507 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35508 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35509 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35510 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35511 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35512 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35514 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35515 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35516 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35518 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35519 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35520 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35521 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35525 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35526 darcy@austen.fict.example
35528 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35530 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35531 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35532 line is of the following form:
35534 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35535 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35537 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35538 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35539 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35540 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35541 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35542 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35543 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35544 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35547 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35548 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35549 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35550 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35551 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35555 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35556 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35557 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35558 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35559 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35560 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35561 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35562 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35563 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35564 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35567 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35568 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35569 typical set of headers:
35571 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35572 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35573 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35574 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35575 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35576 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35577 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35578 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35579 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35580 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35581 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35583 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35584 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35585 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35586 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35587 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35588 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35593 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35597 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35598 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35599 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35600 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35602 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35603 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35605 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35607 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35608 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35610 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35611 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35612 different signature contexts.
35615 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35616 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35617 Exim's standard controls.
35619 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35620 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35621 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35622 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35624 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35625 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35626 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35627 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35629 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35630 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35631 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35632 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35636 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35637 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35639 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35640 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35642 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35644 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35645 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35647 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35649 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35650 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35651 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35652 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35654 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35656 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35657 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35658 The result can either
35660 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35662 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35665 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35666 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35670 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35672 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35673 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35674 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35675 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35677 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35679 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35680 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35681 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35682 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35685 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35687 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35688 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35689 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35693 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35694 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35696 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35697 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35698 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35700 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35701 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35702 runtime of the ACL.
35704 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35705 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35706 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35707 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35709 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35710 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35711 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35712 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35713 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35714 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35717 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35719 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35720 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35721 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35723 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35725 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35726 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35727 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35729 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35732 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35733 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35736 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35737 available (from most to least important):
35741 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35742 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35743 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35744 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35745 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35746 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35748 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35749 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35751 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35752 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35754 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35755 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35757 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35759 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35760 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35761 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35763 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35764 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35766 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35767 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35769 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35770 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35771 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35773 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35774 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35775 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35776 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35778 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35779 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35780 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35781 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35782 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35783 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35784 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35785 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35786 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35787 The key record selector string.
35788 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35789 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35790 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35791 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35792 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35793 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35794 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35795 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35796 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35797 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35798 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35799 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35800 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35801 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35802 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35803 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35804 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35805 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35806 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35807 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35808 integer size comparisons against this value.
35809 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35810 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35811 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35812 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35813 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35814 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35815 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35816 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35818 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35819 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35821 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35822 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35825 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35828 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35829 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35830 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35831 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35832 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35835 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
35836 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35837 sender_domains = gmail.com
35838 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35842 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
35843 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35844 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35845 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
35848 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
35849 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35850 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35851 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35854 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35855 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35856 for more information of what they mean.
35859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35862 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35863 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35864 .cindex "adding drivers"
35865 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
35866 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35867 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35868 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35871 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35872 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35874 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35876 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35878 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35879 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35880 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35882 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35884 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35887 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35888 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35890 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35891 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35892 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35894 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35897 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35898 as for other drivers and lookups.
35901 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35902 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35903 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35904 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35905 searched using a binary chop procedure.
35907 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35908 the interface that is expected.
35913 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35916 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35917 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35918 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35919 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35921 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35926 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35927 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35931 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
35932 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35933 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35936 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35937 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////